|  | /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Copyright (C) 1986-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc. | 
|  |  | 
|  | This file is part of GDB. | 
|  |  | 
|  | This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify | 
|  | it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by | 
|  | the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or | 
|  | (at your option) any later version. | 
|  |  | 
|  | This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, | 
|  | but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of | 
|  | MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the | 
|  | GNU General Public License for more details. | 
|  |  | 
|  | You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License | 
|  | along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | #include "defs.h" | 
|  | #include "arch-utils.h" | 
|  | #include <ctype.h> | 
|  | #include "hashtab.h" | 
|  | #include "symtab.h" | 
|  | #include "frame.h" | 
|  | #include "breakpoint.h" | 
|  | #include "tracepoint.h" | 
|  | #include "gdbtypes.h" | 
|  | #include "expression.h" | 
|  | #include "gdbcore.h" | 
|  | #include "gdbcmd.h" | 
|  | #include "value.h" | 
|  | #include "command.h" | 
|  | #include "inferior.h" | 
|  | #include "infrun.h" | 
|  | #include "gdbthread.h" | 
|  | #include "target.h" | 
|  | #include "language.h" | 
|  | #include "gdb-demangle.h" | 
|  | #include "filenames.h" | 
|  | #include "annotate.h" | 
|  | #include "symfile.h" | 
|  | #include "objfiles.h" | 
|  | #include "source.h" | 
|  | #include "linespec.h" | 
|  | #include "completer.h" | 
|  | #include "gdb.h" | 
|  | #include "ui-out.h" | 
|  | #include "cli/cli-script.h" | 
|  | #include "block.h" | 
|  | #include "solib.h" | 
|  | #include "solist.h" | 
|  | #include "observer.h" | 
|  | #include "memattr.h" | 
|  | #include "ada-lang.h" | 
|  | #include "top.h" | 
|  | #include "valprint.h" | 
|  | #include "jit.h" | 
|  | #include "parser-defs.h" | 
|  | #include "gdb_regex.h" | 
|  | #include "probe.h" | 
|  | #include "cli/cli-utils.h" | 
|  | #include "continuations.h" | 
|  | #include "stack.h" | 
|  | #include "skip.h" | 
|  | #include "ax-gdb.h" | 
|  | #include "dummy-frame.h" | 
|  | #include "interps.h" | 
|  | #include "format.h" | 
|  | #include "location.h" | 
|  | #include "thread-fsm.h" | 
|  | #include "tid-parse.h" | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* readline include files */ | 
|  | #include "readline/readline.h" | 
|  | #include "readline/history.h" | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* readline defines this.  */ | 
|  | #undef savestring | 
|  |  | 
|  | #include "mi/mi-common.h" | 
|  | #include "extension.h" | 
|  | #include <algorithm> | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Enums for exception-handling support.  */ | 
|  | enum exception_event_kind | 
|  | { | 
|  | EX_EVENT_THROW, | 
|  | EX_EVENT_RETHROW, | 
|  | EX_EVENT_CATCH | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Prototypes for local functions.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void enable_delete_command (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void enable_once_command (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void enable_count_command (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void disable_command (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void enable_command (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *, | 
|  | void (*) (struct breakpoint *, | 
|  | void *), | 
|  | void *); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void ignore_command (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location, | 
|  | struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
|  | enum bptype type_wanted); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *, | 
|  | struct linespec_result *, | 
|  | char *, char *, enum bptype, | 
|  | enum bpdisp, int, int, | 
|  | int, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *, | 
|  | int, int, int, unsigned); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | const struct event_location *location, | 
|  | struct program_space *search_pspace, | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines *sals); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void clear_command (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void catch_command (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void mention (struct breakpoint *); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *, | 
|  | enum bptype, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *); | 
|  | static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *, | 
|  | const struct symtab_and_line *); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made | 
|  | static.  */ | 
|  | struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | struct symtab_and_line, | 
|  | enum bptype, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct breakpoint * | 
|  | momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig, | 
|  | enum bptype type, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, | 
|  | int loc_enabled); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR bpaddr, | 
|  | enum bptype bptype); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *, | 
|  | struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR, | 
|  | struct obj_section *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc2); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl, | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR addr); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *, | 
|  | struct address_space *, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void breakpoints_info (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void watchpoints_info (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int breakpoint_1 (char *, int, | 
|  | int (*) (const struct breakpoint *)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void commands_command (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void condition_command (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *); | 
|  | static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, enum remove_bp_reason); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int watchpoint_check (void *); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except, | 
|  | enum bptype type, | 
|  | int *other_type_used); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void hbreak_command (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void thbreak_command (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp, | 
|  | int count); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc); | 
|  | static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc); | 
|  | static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to | 
|  | insert locations now.  */ | 
|  | enum ugll_insert_mode | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only | 
|  | remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be | 
|  | inserted.  Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints | 
|  | should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't | 
|  | have the side effect of inserting the locations of other | 
|  | breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted | 
|  | returns true on them. | 
|  |  | 
|  | This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g., | 
|  | after an exec, while the target still has execution, but | 
|  | breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* | 
|  | be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the | 
|  | target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from | 
|  | GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from | 
|  | the inferior.  */ | 
|  | UGLL_DONT_INSERT, | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now | 
|  | claims breakpoints should be inserted now.  */ | 
|  | UGLL_MAY_INSERT, | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Insert locations now, irrespective of | 
|  | breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now.  E.g., say all threads are | 
|  | stopped right now, and the user did "continue".  We need to | 
|  | insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but | 
|  | UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because | 
|  | breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point, | 
|  | as no thread is running yet.  */ | 
|  | UGLL_INSERT | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void tracepoints_info (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void delete_trace_command (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void enable_trace_command (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void disable_trace_command (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void trace_pass_command (char *, int); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void set_tracepoint_count (int num); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct bp_location **get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero | 
|  | otherwise.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops | 
|  | that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints | 
|  | (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.).  */ | 
|  | static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Internal breakpoints class type.  */ | 
|  | static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Momentary breakpoints class type.  */ | 
|  | static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Momentary breakpoints for bp_longjmp and bp_exception class type.  */ | 
|  | static struct breakpoint_ops longjmp_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created | 
|  | breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Breakpoints set on probes.  */ | 
|  | static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Dynamic printf class type.  */ | 
|  | struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf.  This is a user | 
|  | option because different output options have different tradeoffs; | 
|  | if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there | 
|  | is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior | 
|  | function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of | 
|  | output to the same place as compiled-in print functions.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb"; | 
|  | static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call"; | 
|  | static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent"; | 
|  | static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = { | 
|  | dprintf_style_gdb, | 
|  | dprintf_style_call, | 
|  | dprintf_style_agent, | 
|  | NULL | 
|  | }; | 
|  | static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to | 
|  | call into the inferior.  The value is simply a string that is | 
|  | copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can | 
|  | evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static char *dprintf_function = ""; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to | 
|  | call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to | 
|  | the call as the first argument, with the format string as the | 
|  | second.  As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that | 
|  | GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like | 
|  | "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like | 
|  | "mystreams[curlogger]".  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static char *dprintf_channel = ""; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB | 
|  | has disconnected.  */ | 
|  | static int disconnected_dprintf = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A reference-counted struct command_line.  This lets multiple | 
|  | breakpoints share a single command list.  */ | 
|  | struct counted_command_line | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The reference count.  */ | 
|  | int refc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The command list.  */ | 
|  | struct command_line *commands; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct command_line * | 
|  | breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the | 
|  | current breakpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int breakpoint_proceeded; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const char * | 
|  | bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and | 
|  | represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at | 
|  | a breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"}; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return bpdisps[(int) disp]; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Prototypes for exported functions.  */ | 
|  | /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even | 
|  | if such is available.  */ | 
|  | static int can_use_hw_watchpoints; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, | 
|  | struct cmd_list_element *c, | 
|  | const char *value) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf_filtered (file, | 
|  | _("Debugger's willingness to use " | 
|  | "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"), | 
|  | value); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints. | 
|  | If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints | 
|  | for unrecognized breakpoint locations. | 
|  | If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized.  */ | 
|  | static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support; | 
|  | static void | 
|  | show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, | 
|  | struct cmd_list_element *c, | 
|  | const char *value) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf_filtered (file, | 
|  | _("Debugger's behavior regarding " | 
|  | "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"), | 
|  | value); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints | 
|  | set with "break" but falling in read-only memory. | 
|  | If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically | 
|  | use hardware breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints; | 
|  | static void | 
|  | show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, | 
|  | struct cmd_list_element *c, | 
|  | const char *value) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf_filtered (file, | 
|  | _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"), | 
|  | value); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is | 
|  | stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as | 
|  | they're created.  If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of | 
|  | the target as long as possible.  That is, it delays inserting | 
|  | breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the | 
|  | target fully stops.  This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while | 
|  | processing user input.  */ | 
|  | static int always_inserted_mode = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, | 
|  | struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"), | 
|  | value); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no | 
|  | thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are | 
|  | no threads under GDB's control yet.  */ | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (target_has_execution) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct thread_info *tp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (always_inserted_mode) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads | 
|  | are stopped.  */ | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (threads_are_executing ()) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are | 
|  | stopped, we still have events to process.  */ | 
|  | ALL_NON_EXITED_THREADS (tp) | 
|  | if (tp->resumed | 
|  | && tp->suspend.waitstatus_pending_p) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target"; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation.  */ | 
|  | static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto"; | 
|  | static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host"; | 
|  | static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target"; | 
|  | static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = { | 
|  | condition_evaluation_auto, | 
|  | condition_evaluation_host, | 
|  | condition_evaluation_target, | 
|  | NULL | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation.  */ | 
|  | static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from | 
|  | condition_evaluation_mode_1.  */ | 
|  | static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host" | 
|  | or "target".  This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the | 
|  | real setting that is being used.  It returns the translated | 
|  | evaluation mode.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static const char * | 
|  | translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | 
|  | return condition_evaluation_target; | 
|  | else | 
|  | return condition_evaluation_host; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | return mode; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static const char * | 
|  | breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false | 
|  | otherwise.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return (mode == condition_evaluation_host); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void _initialize_breakpoint (void); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Are we executing breakpoint commands?  */ | 
|  | static int executing_breakpoint_commands; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */ | 
|  | static int overlay_events_enabled; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See description in breakpoint.h. */ | 
|  | int target_exact_watchpoints = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints. | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the | 
|  | current breakpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B)  for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP)	\ | 
|  | for (B = breakpoint_chain;	\ | 
|  | B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0;	\ | 
|  | B = TMP) | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints.  SAFE variant is | 
|  | not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called | 
|  | while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP)					\ | 
|  | for (BP_TMP = bp_location;					\ | 
|  | BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP);	\ | 
|  | BP_TMP++) | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Iterates through locations with address ADDRESS for the currently selected | 
|  | program space.  BP_LOCP_TMP points to each object.  BP_LOCP_START points | 
|  | to where the loop should start from. | 
|  | If BP_LOCP_START is a NULL pointer, the macro automatically seeks the | 
|  | appropriate location to start with.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR(BP_LOCP_TMP, BP_LOCP_START, ADDRESS)	\ | 
|  | for (BP_LOCP_START = BP_LOCP_START == NULL ? get_first_locp_gte_addr (ADDRESS) : BP_LOCP_START, \ | 
|  | BP_LOCP_TMP = BP_LOCP_START;				\ | 
|  | BP_LOCP_START						\ | 
|  | && (BP_LOCP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count		\ | 
|  | && (*BP_LOCP_TMP)->address == ADDRESS);			\ | 
|  | BP_LOCP_TMP++) | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Iterator for tracepoints only.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B)  \ | 
|  | for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)  \ | 
|  | if (is_tracepoint (B)) | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Chains of all breakpoints defined.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct bp_location **bp_location; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static unsigned bp_location_count; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and | 
|  | ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid | 
|  | result from bp_location_has_shadow.  You can use it for roughly | 
|  | limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for | 
|  | an address you need to read.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS | 
|  | + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of | 
|  | BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow. | 
|  | You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to | 
|  | scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked | 
|  | from bp_location array, but for which a hit may still be reported | 
|  | by a target.  */ | 
|  | VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Number of last breakpoint made.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int breakpoint_count; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that | 
|  | created breakpoints.  If the last (break-like) command created more | 
|  | than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT | 
|  | and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one.  */ | 
|  | static int prev_breakpoint_count; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Number of last tracepoint made.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int tracepoint_count; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist; | 
|  | static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist; | 
|  | struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See declaration at breakpoint.h.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct breakpoint * | 
|  | breakpoint_find_if (int (*func) (struct breakpoint *b, void *d), | 
|  | void *user_data) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (func (b, user_data) != 0) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return b; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set breakpoint count to NUM.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | set_breakpoint_count (int num) | 
|  | { | 
|  | prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count; | 
|  | breakpoint_count = num; | 
|  | set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current | 
|  | breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first | 
|  | breakpoint made.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | start_rbreak_breakpoints (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last | 
|  | breakpoint made.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | end_rbreak_breakpoints (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | b->hit_count = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Allocate a new counted_command_line with reference count of 1. | 
|  | The new structure owns COMMANDS.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct counted_command_line * | 
|  | alloc_counted_command_line (struct command_line *commands) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct counted_command_line *result = XNEW (struct counted_command_line); | 
|  |  | 
|  | result->refc = 1; | 
|  | result->commands = commands; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return result; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Increment reference count.  This does nothing if CMD is NULL.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | incref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line *cmd) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (cmd) | 
|  | ++cmd->refc; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Decrement reference count.  If the reference count reaches 0, | 
|  | destroy the counted_command_line.  Sets *CMDP to NULL.  This does | 
|  | nothing if *CMDP is NULL.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (*cmdp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (--(*cmdp)->refc == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | free_command_lines (&(*cmdp)->commands); | 
|  | xfree (*cmdp); | 
|  | } | 
|  | *cmdp = NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A cleanup function that calls decref_counted_command_line.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | do_cleanup_counted_command_line (void *arg) | 
|  | { | 
|  | decref_counted_command_line ((struct counted_command_line **) arg); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Create a cleanup that calls decref_counted_command_line on the | 
|  | argument.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct cleanup * | 
|  | make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return make_cleanup (do_cleanup_counted_command_line, cmdp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL | 
|  | if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct breakpoint * | 
|  | get_breakpoint (int num) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | if (b->number == num) | 
|  | return b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports | 
|  | evaluating conditions on its side.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This is only meaningful if the target is | 
|  | evaluating conditions and if the user has | 
|  | opted for condition evaluation on the target's | 
|  | side.  */ | 
|  | if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () | 
|  | || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!is_breakpoint (b)) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next) | 
|  | loc->condition_changed = condition_modified; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports | 
|  | evaluating conditions on its side.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* This is only meaningful if the target is | 
|  | evaluating conditions and if the user has | 
|  | opted for condition evaluation on the target's | 
|  | side.  */ | 
|  | if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () | 
|  | || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | 
|  |  | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | loc->condition_changed = condition_modified; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global | 
|  | condition_evaluation_mode.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | set_condition_evaluation_mode (char *args, int from_tty, | 
|  | struct cmd_list_element *c) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *old_mode, *new_mode; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target) | 
|  | && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | 
|  | { | 
|  | condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode; | 
|  | warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n" | 
|  | "Using host evaluation mode instead.")); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1); | 
|  | old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Flip the switch.  Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the | 
|  | settings was "auto".  */ | 
|  | condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one.  */ | 
|  | if (new_mode != old_mode) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp; | 
|  | /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we | 
|  | need to synch the changes with the target as follows: | 
|  |  | 
|  | "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target. | 
|  | "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target. | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the | 
|  | target.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp) | 
|  | mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions | 
|  | with the target.  We do this to remove all the conditions the | 
|  | target knows about.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp) | 
|  | if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted) | 
|  | loc->needs_update = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Do the update.  */ | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation.  Explicitly shows | 
|  | what "auto" is translating to.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, | 
|  | struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto) | 
|  | fprintf_filtered (file, | 
|  | _("Breakpoint condition evaluation " | 
|  | "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"), | 
|  | value, | 
|  | breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()); | 
|  | else | 
|  | fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"), | 
|  | value); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP that is used by | 
|  | bsearch.  This comparison function only cares about addresses, unlike | 
|  | the more general bp_location_compare function.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | bp_location_compare_addrs (const void *ap, const void *bp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap; | 
|  | const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (a->address == b->address) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | else | 
|  | return ((a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Helper function to skip all bp_locations with addresses | 
|  | less than ADDRESS.  It returns the first bp_location that | 
|  | is greater than or equal to ADDRESS.  If none is found, just | 
|  | return NULL.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct bp_location ** | 
|  | get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location dummy_loc; | 
|  | struct bp_location *dummy_locp = &dummy_loc; | 
|  | struct bp_location **locp_found = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Initialize the dummy location's address field.  */ | 
|  | memset (&dummy_loc, 0, sizeof (struct bp_location)); | 
|  | dummy_loc.address = address; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Find a close match to the first location at ADDRESS.  */ | 
|  | locp_found = ((struct bp_location **) | 
|  | bsearch (&dummy_locp, bp_location, bp_location_count, | 
|  | sizeof (struct bp_location **), | 
|  | bp_location_compare_addrs)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Nothing was found, nothing left to do.  */ | 
|  | if (locp_found == NULL) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We may have found a location that is at ADDRESS but is not the first in the | 
|  | location's list.  Go backwards (if possible) and locate the first one.  */ | 
|  | while ((locp_found - 1) >= bp_location | 
|  | && (*(locp_found - 1))->address == address) | 
|  | locp_found--; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return locp_found; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp, | 
|  | int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | xfree (b->cond_string); | 
|  | b->cond_string = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (is_watchpoint (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | w->cond_exp.reset (); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | loc->cond.reset (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* No need to free the condition agent expression | 
|  | bytecode (if we have one).  We will handle this | 
|  | when we go through update_global_location_list.  */ | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (*exp == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (from_tty) | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *arg = exp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user | 
|  | typed in or the decompiled expression.  */ | 
|  | b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg); | 
|  | b->condition_not_parsed = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (is_watchpoint (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | innermost_block = NULL; | 
|  | arg = exp; | 
|  | w->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0); | 
|  | if (*arg) | 
|  | error (_("Junk at end of expression")); | 
|  | w->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | arg = exp; | 
|  | loc->cond = | 
|  | parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address, | 
|  | block_for_pc (loc->address), 0); | 
|  | if (*arg) | 
|  | error (_("Junk at end of expression")); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | mark_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
|  |  | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Completion for the "condition" command.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static VEC (char_ptr) * | 
|  | condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd, | 
|  | const char *text, const char *word) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *space; | 
|  |  | 
|  | text = skip_spaces_const (text); | 
|  | space = skip_to_space_const (text); | 
|  | if (*space == '\0') | 
|  | { | 
|  | int len; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | VEC (char_ptr) *result = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (text[0] == '$') | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We don't support completion of history indices.  */ | 
|  | if (isdigit (text[1])) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | return complete_internalvar (&text[1]); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We're completing the breakpoint number.  */ | 
|  | len = strlen (text); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char number[50]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0) | 
|  | VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, result, xstrdup (number)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return result; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We're completing the expression part.  */ | 
|  | text = skip_spaces_const (space); | 
|  | return expression_completer (cmd, text, word); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | char *p; | 
|  | int bnum; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (arg == 0) | 
|  | error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | p = arg; | 
|  | bnum = get_number (&p); | 
|  | if (bnum == 0) | 
|  | error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | if (b->number == bnum) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an | 
|  | extension language.  This method and conditions entered into GDB | 
|  | from the CLI are mutually exclusive.  */ | 
|  | const struct extension_language_defn *extlang | 
|  | = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (extlang != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | error (_("Only one stop condition allowed.  There is currently" | 
|  | " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."), | 
|  | ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (is_breakpoint (b)) | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable | 
|  | only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints. | 
|  | Throw if any such commands is found.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct command_line *c; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (c = commands; c; c = c->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control) | 
|  | error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can " | 
|  | "only be used for tracepoints")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0; i < c->body_count; ++i) | 
|  | check_no_tracepoint_commands ((c->body_list)[i]); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment | 
|  | lines and also empty lines.  So, we only need to check for | 
|  | command directly.  */ | 
|  | if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line) | 
|  | error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line) | 
|  | error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints")); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | is_tracepoint_type (enum bptype type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return (type == bp_tracepoint | 
|  | || type == bp_fast_tracepoint | 
|  | || type == bp_static_tracepoint); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return is_tracepoint_type (b->type); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a | 
|  | breakpoint.  This function will throw an exception if a problem is | 
|  | found.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | struct command_line *commands) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (is_tracepoint (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b; | 
|  | struct command_line *c; | 
|  | struct command_line *while_stepping = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Reset the while-stepping step count.  The previous commands | 
|  | might have included a while-stepping action, while the new | 
|  | ones might not.  */ | 
|  | t->step_count = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is | 
|  | valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one | 
|  | while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body | 
|  | has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping. | 
|  | We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the | 
|  | context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually | 
|  | has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's | 
|  | while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the | 
|  | collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the | 
|  | tracepoint's context.  */ | 
|  | for (c = commands; c; c = c->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint) | 
|  | error (_("The 'while-stepping' command " | 
|  | "cannot be used for fast tracepoint")); | 
|  | else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint) | 
|  | error (_("The 'while-stepping' command " | 
|  | "cannot be used for static tracepoint")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (while_stepping) | 
|  | error (_("The 'while-stepping' command " | 
|  | "can be used only once")); | 
|  | else | 
|  | while_stepping = c; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | validate_actionline (c->line, b); | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (while_stepping) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct command_line *c2; | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_count == 1); | 
|  | c2 = while_stepping->body_list[0]; | 
|  | for (; c2; c2 = c2->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control) | 
|  | error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested")); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR.  The | 
|  | caller is responsible for releasing the vector.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | VEC(breakpoint_p) * | 
|  | static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0; | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next) | 
|  | if (loc->address == addr) | 
|  | VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return found; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS.  If breakpoint is tracepoint, | 
|  | validate that only allowed commands are included.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | struct command_line *commands) | 
|  | { | 
|  | validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands); | 
|  |  | 
|  | decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands); | 
|  | b->commands = alloc_counted_command_line (commands); | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint.  Note that this | 
|  | is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's | 
|  | commands.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int old_silent = b->silent; | 
|  |  | 
|  | b->silent = silent; | 
|  | if (old_silent != silent) | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set the thread for this breakpoint.  If THREAD is -1, make the | 
|  | breakpoint work for any thread.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int old_thread = b->thread; | 
|  |  | 
|  | b->thread = thread; | 
|  | if (old_thread != thread) | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set the task for this breakpoint.  If TASK is 0, make the | 
|  | breakpoint work for any task.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int old_task = b->task; | 
|  |  | 
|  | b->task = task; | 
|  | if (old_task != task) | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | check_tracepoint_command (char *line, void *closure) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) closure; | 
|  |  | 
|  | validate_actionline (line, b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A structure used to pass information through | 
|  | map_breakpoint_numbers.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct commands_info | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* True if the command was typed at a tty.  */ | 
|  | int from_tty; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The breakpoint range spec.  */ | 
|  | const char *arg; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Non-NULL if the body of the commands are being read from this | 
|  | already-parsed command.  */ | 
|  | struct command_line *control; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The command lines read from the user, or NULL if they have not | 
|  | yet been read.  */ | 
|  | struct counted_command_line *cmd; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that sets the commands for | 
|  | commands_command.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | do_map_commands_command (struct breakpoint *b, void *data) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct commands_info *info = (struct commands_info *) data; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (info->cmd == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct command_line *l; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (info->control != NULL) | 
|  | l = copy_command_lines (info->control->body_list[0]); | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain; | 
|  | char *str; | 
|  |  | 
|  | str = xstrprintf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) " | 
|  | "%s, one per line."), | 
|  | info->arg); | 
|  |  | 
|  | old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, str); | 
|  |  | 
|  | l = read_command_lines (str, | 
|  | info->from_tty, 1, | 
|  | (is_tracepoint (b) | 
|  | ? check_tracepoint_command : 0), | 
|  | b); | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | info->cmd = alloc_counted_command_line (l); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to | 
|  | do anything.  */ | 
|  | if (b->commands != info->cmd) | 
|  | { | 
|  | validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, info->cmd->commands); | 
|  | incref_counted_command_line (info->cmd); | 
|  | decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands); | 
|  | b->commands = info->cmd; | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | commands_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty, | 
|  | struct command_line *control) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanups; | 
|  | struct commands_info info; | 
|  |  | 
|  | info.from_tty = from_tty; | 
|  | info.control = control; | 
|  | info.cmd = NULL; | 
|  | /* If we read command lines from the user, then `info' will hold an | 
|  | extra reference to the commands that we must clean up.  */ | 
|  | cleanups = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&info.cmd); | 
|  |  | 
|  | std::string new_arg; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (arg == NULL || !*arg) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1) | 
|  | new_arg = string_printf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1, | 
|  | breakpoint_count); | 
|  | else if (breakpoint_count > 0) | 
|  | new_arg = string_printf ("%d", breakpoint_count); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | new_arg = arg; | 
|  |  | 
|  | info.arg = new_arg.c_str (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | map_breakpoint_numbers (info.arg, do_map_commands_command, &info); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (info.cmd == NULL) | 
|  | error (_("No breakpoints specified.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanups); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from | 
|  | input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure. | 
|  |  | 
|  | This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands | 
|  | that are part of if and while bodies.  */ | 
|  | enum command_control_type | 
|  | commands_from_control_command (const char *arg, struct command_line *cmd) | 
|  | { | 
|  | commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd); | 
|  | return simple_control; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | if (!bl->inserted) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0) | 
|  | /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory.  */ | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address | 
|  | MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed | 
|  | contents. | 
|  |  | 
|  | If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of | 
|  | the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer.  Otherwise, a | 
|  | failed assertion internal error will be raised.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf, | 
|  | const gdb_byte *writebuf_org, | 
|  | ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len, | 
|  | struct bp_target_info *target_info, | 
|  | struct gdbarch *gdbarch) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements.  */ | 
|  | CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0; | 
|  | int bp_size = 0; | 
|  | int bptoffset = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0, | 
|  | current_program_space->aspace, 0)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space.  */ | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that | 
|  | we need to copy.  */ | 
|  | bp_addr = target_info->placed_address; | 
|  | bp_size = target_info->shadow_len; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are | 
|  | reading.  */ | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are | 
|  | reading.  */ | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Offset within shadow_contents.  */ | 
|  | if (bp_addr < memaddr) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr; | 
|  | bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr; | 
|  | bp_addr = memaddr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (readbuf != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the | 
|  | shadow_contents buffer.  */ | 
|  | gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len | 
|  | || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents | 
|  | + target_info->shadow_len)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's | 
|  | shadow.  */ | 
|  | memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr, | 
|  | target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | const unsigned char *bp; | 
|  | CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address; | 
|  | int placed_size; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory.  */ | 
|  | memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, | 
|  | writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this | 
|  | address.  */ | 
|  | bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted | 
|  | breakpoint's INSN.  */ | 
|  | memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR, | 
|  | by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents. | 
|  |  | 
|  | If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of | 
|  | the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers.  Otherwise, | 
|  | a failed assertion internal error will be raised. | 
|  |  | 
|  | The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is: | 
|  | bl->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max | 
|  | up to bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max | 
|  | The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is: | 
|  | memaddr ... memaddr + len | 
|  | Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are | 
|  | memaddr + len <= (bl->address | 
|  | - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max) | 
|  | and: | 
|  | bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf, | 
|  | const gdb_byte *writebuf_org, | 
|  | ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary | 
|  | search.  */ | 
|  | unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF | 
|  | content.  It is safe to report lower value but a failure to | 
|  | report higher one.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | bc_l = 0; | 
|  | bc_r = bp_location_count; | 
|  | while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2; | 
|  | bl = bp_location[bc]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added | 
|  | constant.  Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure | 
|  | the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR | 
|  | to MEMADDR + LEN range). | 
|  |  | 
|  | Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety | 
|  | offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow | 
|  | range tail still reaching MEMADDR.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max | 
|  | >= bl->address) | 
|  | && (bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max | 
|  | <= memaddr)) | 
|  | bc_l = bc; | 
|  | else | 
|  | bc_r = bc; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the | 
|  | first location that's at BC_L's address.  E.g., if there are | 
|  | multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing | 
|  | at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted" | 
|  | location.  Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and | 
|  | B: | 
|  |  | 
|  | L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ... | 
|  |  | 
|  | BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master" | 
|  | location could be L1.  Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set | 
|  | on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1 | 
|  | and L2.  */ | 
|  | while (bc_l > 0 | 
|  | && bp_location[bc_l]->address == bp_location[bc_l - 1]->address) | 
|  | bc_l--; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl = bp_location[bc]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL.  */ | 
|  | if (bl->owner->type == bp_none) | 
|  | warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"), | 
|  | bl->owner->number); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF | 
|  | content.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bl->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max | 
|  | && memaddr + len <= (bl->address | 
|  | - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)) | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org, | 
|  | memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return true if BPT is either a software breakpoint or a hardware | 
|  | breakpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint | 
|  | || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint | 
|  | || bpt->type == bp_dprintf); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint | 
|  | || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint | 
|  | || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or | 
|  | software.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt) | 
|  | || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe | 
|  | to evaluate or update watchpoint B.  Watchpoints on local | 
|  | expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that | 
|  | was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs | 
|  | to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context. | 
|  | Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread, | 
|  | and in any state.  It is presently left to the target allowing | 
|  | memory accesses when threads are running.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return (b->base.pspace == current_program_space | 
|  | && (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid) | 
|  | || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread) | 
|  | && !is_executing (inferior_ptid)))); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible | 
|  | associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = &w->base; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (b->related_breakpoint != b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | gdb_assert (b->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope); | 
|  | gdb_assert (b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == b); | 
|  | b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop; | 
|  | b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint; | 
|  | b->related_breakpoint = b; | 
|  | } | 
|  | b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in | 
|  | watchpoint W.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct value * | 
|  | extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct value *bit_val; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (val == NULL) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val, | 
|  | w->val_bitpos, | 
|  | w->val_bitsize, | 
|  | value_contents_for_printing (val), | 
|  | value_offset (val), | 
|  | val); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return bit_val; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B, which must be a software | 
|  | watchpoint.  This is required because even if a software watchpoint | 
|  | is not watching any memory, bpstat_stop_status requires a location | 
|  | to be able to report stops.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | struct program_space *pspace) | 
|  | { | 
|  | gdb_assert (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b); | 
|  | b->loc->pspace = pspace; | 
|  | b->loc->address = -1; | 
|  | b->loc->length = -1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Returns true if B is a software watchpoint that is not watching any | 
|  | memory (e.g., "watch $pc").  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return (b->type == bp_watchpoint | 
|  | && b->loc != NULL | 
|  | && b->loc->next == NULL | 
|  | && b->loc->address == -1 | 
|  | && b->loc->length == -1); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint: | 
|  | - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero | 
|  | - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val | 
|  | - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result | 
|  | in b->loc->cond. | 
|  | - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc. | 
|  |  | 
|  | If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do | 
|  | nothing.  If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete | 
|  | it. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are | 
|  | removed + inserted on each stop here.  Normal breakpoints must | 
|  | never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread | 
|  | when debugging in non-stop mode.  On the other hand, hardware | 
|  | watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific | 
|  | to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug | 
|  | registers.  Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to | 
|  | be able to modify its hardware watchpoints. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being | 
|  | presented to the user.  It cannot be done sooner, because it would | 
|  | reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user.  And | 
|  | it must not be done later because it could display the same single | 
|  | watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops.  Note that the latter is | 
|  | relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint | 
|  | and bp_access_watchpoint.  False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is | 
|  | not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has | 
|  | not changed. | 
|  |  | 
|  | The following constraints influence the location where we can reset | 
|  | hardware watchpoints: | 
|  |  | 
|  | * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are | 
|  | called several times when GDB stops. | 
|  |  | 
|  | [linux] | 
|  | * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time, | 
|  | causing GDB to stop.  GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint | 
|  | hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits | 
|  | are presented later, one after the other, each time the user | 
|  | requests the execution to be resumed.  Execution is not resumed | 
|  | for the threads still having pending hit event stored in | 
|  | LWP_INFO->STATUS.  While the watchpoint is already removed from | 
|  | the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being | 
|  | reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address | 
|  | until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets | 
|  | presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the | 
|  | watchpoint removal from inferior.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int within_current_scope; | 
|  | struct frame_id saved_frame_id; | 
|  | int frame_saved; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the | 
|  | watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread | 
|  | that was used to create the watchpoint.  */ | 
|  | if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b)) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (b->base.disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | frame_saved = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope.  */ | 
|  | if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL) | 
|  | within_current_scope = 1; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame (); | 
|  | struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi); | 
|  | CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed | 
|  | (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work | 
|  | properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this | 
|  | point.  See similar comments in watchpoint_check.  */ | 
|  | if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc)) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after | 
|  | evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame.  */ | 
|  | /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression | 
|  | took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the | 
|  | selected frame.  */ | 
|  | frame_saved = 1; | 
|  | saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame); | 
|  | within_current_scope = (fi != NULL); | 
|  | if (within_current_scope) | 
|  | select_frame (fi); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We don't free locations.  They are stored in the bp_location array | 
|  | and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and | 
|  | remove breakpoints if needed.  */ | 
|  | b->base.loc = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (within_current_scope && reparse) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *s; | 
|  |  | 
|  | b->exp.reset (); | 
|  | s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string; | 
|  | b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0); | 
|  | /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is | 
|  | no longer relevant.  We don't want to report a watchpoint hit | 
|  | to the user when the old value and the new value may actually | 
|  | be completely different objects.  */ | 
|  | value_free (b->val); | 
|  | b->val = NULL; | 
|  | b->val_valid = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition | 
|  | expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the | 
|  | locations (re)created below.  */ | 
|  | if (b->base.cond_string != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | b->cond_exp.reset (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | s = b->base.cond_string; | 
|  | b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because | 
|  | it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library, | 
|  | don't try to insert watchpoint.  We don't automatically delete | 
|  | such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression | 
|  | is different from out-of-scope watchpoint.  */ | 
|  | if (!target_has_execution) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Without execution, memory can't change.  No use to try and | 
|  | set watchpoint locations.  The watchpoint will be reset when | 
|  | the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set.  */ | 
|  | if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base)) | 
|  | b->base.type = bp_watchpoint; | 
|  | else | 
|  | error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when " | 
|  | "hardware watchpoints are disabled.")); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (within_current_scope && b->exp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int pc = 0; | 
|  | struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next; | 
|  | struct program_space *frame_pspace; | 
|  |  | 
|  | fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set.  The meaning of | 
|  | b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update | 
|  | it only if we reported that last value to user.  As it | 
|  | happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly. | 
|  | We don't keep track of the memory value for masked | 
|  | watchpoints.  */ | 
|  | if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (&b->base)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b->val_bitsize != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v); | 
|  | if (v != NULL) | 
|  | release_value (v); | 
|  | } | 
|  | b->val = v; | 
|  | b->val_valid = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Look at each value on the value chain.  */ | 
|  | for (v = val_chain; v; v = value_next (v)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed | 
|  | its contents to evaluate the expression, then we | 
|  | must watch it.  If the first value returned is | 
|  | still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it; | 
|  | watch it anyway in case it becomes readable.  */ | 
|  | if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory | 
|  | && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked | 
|  | for it explicitly, never if they just happen to | 
|  | appear in the middle of some value chain.  */ | 
|  | if (v == result | 
|  | || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT | 
|  | && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | CORE_ADDR addr; | 
|  | enum target_hw_bp_type type; | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc, **tmp; | 
|  | int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (value_bitsize (v) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield | 
|  | sub-expression.  */ | 
|  | bitpos = value_bitpos (v); | 
|  | bitsize = value_bitsize (v); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield | 
|  | lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields | 
|  | VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE.  */ | 
|  | bitpos = b->val_bitpos; | 
|  | bitsize = b->val_bitsize; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | addr = value_address (v); | 
|  | if (bitsize != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield.  */ | 
|  | addr += bitpos / 8; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | type = hw_write; | 
|  | if (b->base.type == bp_read_watchpoint) | 
|  | type = hw_read; | 
|  | else if (b->base.type == bp_access_watchpoint) | 
|  | type = hw_access; | 
|  |  | 
|  | loc = allocate_bp_location (&b->base); | 
|  | for (tmp = &(b->base.loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next)) | 
|  | ; | 
|  | *tmp = loc; | 
|  | loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | loc->pspace = frame_pspace; | 
|  | loc->address = addr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bitsize != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield.  */ | 
|  | loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | loc->watchpoint_type = type; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or | 
|  | an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support | 
|  | and free hardware slots.  REPARSE is set when the inferior | 
|  | is started.  */ | 
|  | if (reparse) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int reg_cnt; | 
|  | enum bp_loc_type loc_type; | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl; | 
|  |  | 
|  | reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (reg_cnt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used; | 
|  | enum bptype type; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be | 
|  | watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it.  */ | 
|  | b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We need to determine how many resources are already | 
|  | used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one | 
|  | to see if we still have enough resources to also fit | 
|  | this watchpoint in as well.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it | 
|  | to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of | 
|  | hardware watchpoint type.  */ | 
|  | type = b->base.type; | 
|  | if (type == bp_watchpoint) | 
|  | type = bp_hardware_watchpoint; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on | 
|  | the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list | 
|  | if we're trying to create it for the first time, | 
|  | through watch_command), so always account for it | 
|  | manually.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B.  */ | 
|  | i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (&b->base, type, &other_type_used); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add in the resources needed for B.  */ | 
|  | i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (&b->base); | 
|  |  | 
|  | target_resources_ok | 
|  | = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used); | 
|  | if (target_resources_ok <= 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int sw_mode = b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode) | 
|  | error (_("Target does not support this type of " | 
|  | "hardware watchpoint.")); | 
|  | else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode) | 
|  | error (_("There are not enough available hardware " | 
|  | "resources for this watchpoint.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Downgrade to software watchpoint.  */ | 
|  | b->base.type = bp_watchpoint; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just | 
|  | found we have enough resources to turn it to a | 
|  | hardware watchpoint.  Otherwise, this is a | 
|  | nop.  */ | 
|  | b->base.type = type; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (!b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints) | 
|  | error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when " | 
|  | "hardware watchpoints are disabled.")); | 
|  | else | 
|  | error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with " | 
|  | "read/access watchpoint.")); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | b->base.type = bp_watchpoint; | 
|  |  | 
|  | loc_type = (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other | 
|  | : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint); | 
|  | for (bl = b->base.loc; bl; bl = bl->next) | 
|  | bl->loc_type = loc_type; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (v = val_chain; v; v = next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | next = value_next (v); | 
|  | if (v != b->val) | 
|  | value_free (v); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the | 
|  | above left it without any location set up.  But, | 
|  | bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report | 
|  | stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one.  */ | 
|  | if (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint && b->base.loc == NULL) | 
|  | software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (&b->base, frame_pspace); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (!within_current_scope) | 
|  | { | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("\ | 
|  | Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\ | 
|  | in which its expression is valid.\n"), | 
|  | b->base.number); | 
|  | watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Restore the selected frame.  */ | 
|  | if (frame_saved) | 
|  | select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be | 
|  | inserted in the inferior.  We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner | 
|  | (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's | 
|  | breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location, | 
|  | tracepoint's insert_location will not be called.  */ | 
|  | static int | 
|  | should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a | 
|  | vfork, and have detached from the child.  The child is running | 
|  | free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the | 
|  | OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports | 
|  | that the vfork is done).  Until the child is done with the shared | 
|  | memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise | 
|  | the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints.  Since | 
|  | the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its | 
|  | location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint, | 
|  | and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past | 
|  | a breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
|  | || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace, | 
|  | bl->address) | 
|  | /* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location | 
|  | we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself. | 
|  | However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may | 
|  | break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the | 
|  | instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags. | 
|  | We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction | 
|  | or switch to displaced stepping.  */ | 
|  | && !(bl->owner->type == bp_single_step | 
|  | && thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl->owner->thread))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (debug_infrun) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, | 
|  | "infrun: skipping breakpoint: " | 
|  | "stepping past insn at: %s\n", | 
|  | paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the | 
|  | instruction that triggered one.  */ | 
|  | if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint) | 
|  | && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ()) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (debug_infrun) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, | 
|  | "infrun: stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. " | 
|  | "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d\n", | 
|  | paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address), | 
|  | bl->length); | 
|  | } | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming | 
|  | that the location is not duplicated.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int result; | 
|  | const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bl->duplicate = 0; | 
|  | result = should_be_inserted (bl); | 
|  | bl->duplicate = save_duplicate; | 
|  | return result; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an | 
|  | agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation | 
|  | by the bytecode interpreter.  Return NULL if there was | 
|  | any error during parsing.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static agent_expr_up | 
|  | parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (cond == NULL) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | agent_expr_up aexpr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors | 
|  | that may show up.  */ | 
|  | TRY | 
|  | { | 
|  | aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid | 
|  | bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side. | 
|  | It's no use iterating through the conditions.  */ | 
|  | } | 
|  | END_CATCH | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We have a valid agent expression.  */ | 
|  | return aexpr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be | 
|  | passed on to the target.  If we have duplicated locations with different | 
|  | conditions, we will add such conditions to the list.  The idea is that the | 
|  | target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when | 
|  | one of them is true.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p; | 
|  | int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0; | 
|  | int modified = bl->needs_update; | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert.  */ | 
|  | bl->target_info.conditions.clear (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This is only meaningful if the target is | 
|  | evaluating conditions and if the user has | 
|  | opted for condition evaluation on the target's | 
|  | side.  */ | 
|  | if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () | 
|  | || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned | 
|  | conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression | 
|  | bytecode.  If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions | 
|  | to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a | 
|  | response back to GDB.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address) | 
|  | { | 
|  | loc = (*loc2p); | 
|  | if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (modified) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed.  In that | 
|  | case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see | 
|  | force_breakpoint_reinsertion).  We just | 
|  | need to parse the condition to bytecodes again.  */ | 
|  | loc->cond_bytecode = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address, | 
|  | loc->cond.get ()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something | 
|  | went wrong or we have a null condition expression.  */ | 
|  | if (!loc->cond_bytecode) | 
|  | { | 
|  | null_condition_or_parse_error = 1; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions | 
|  | for the location's address on gdb's side.  It is no use keeping bytecodes | 
|  | for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here. | 
|  |  | 
|  | This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are | 
|  | being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub.  */ | 
|  | if (null_condition_or_parse_error) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address) | 
|  | { | 
|  | loc = (*loc2p); | 
|  | if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is | 
|  | located.  */ | 
|  | if (!loc->cond_bytecode) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | loc->cond_bytecode.reset (); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation.  Build a condition list | 
|  | for this location's address.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address) | 
|  | { | 
|  | loc = (*loc2p); | 
|  | if (loc->cond | 
|  | && is_breakpoint (loc->owner) | 
|  | && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num | 
|  | && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled | 
|  | && loc->enabled) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Add the condition to the vector.  This will be used later | 
|  | to send the conditions to the target.  */ | 
|  | bl->target_info.conditions.push_back (loc->cond_bytecode.get ()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression | 
|  | bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter. | 
|  | Return NULL if there was any error during parsing.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static agent_expr_up | 
|  | parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_cleanups = 0; | 
|  | struct expression **argvec; | 
|  | const char *cmdrest; | 
|  | const char *format_start, *format_end; | 
|  | struct format_piece *fpieces; | 
|  | int nargs; | 
|  | struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (cmd == NULL) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | cmdrest = cmd; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (*cmdrest == ',') | 
|  | ++cmdrest; | 
|  | cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (*cmdrest++ != '"') | 
|  | error (_("No format string following the location")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | format_start = cmdrest; | 
|  |  | 
|  | fpieces = parse_format_string (&cmdrest); | 
|  |  | 
|  | old_cleanups = make_cleanup (free_format_pieces_cleanup, &fpieces); | 
|  |  | 
|  | format_end = cmdrest; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (*cmdrest++ != '"') | 
|  | error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0')) | 
|  | error (_("Invalid argument syntax")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (*cmdrest == ',') | 
|  | cmdrest++; | 
|  | cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* For each argument, make an expression.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | argvec = (struct expression **) alloca (strlen (cmd) | 
|  | * sizeof (struct expression *)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | nargs = 0; | 
|  | while (*cmdrest != '\0') | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *cmd1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | cmd1 = cmdrest; | 
|  | expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1); | 
|  | argvec[nargs++] = expr.release (); | 
|  | cmdrest = cmd1; | 
|  | if (*cmdrest == ',') | 
|  | ++cmdrest; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | agent_expr_up aexpr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors | 
|  | that may show up.  */ | 
|  | TRY | 
|  | { | 
|  | aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0, | 
|  | format_start, format_end - format_start, | 
|  | fpieces, nargs, argvec); | 
|  | } | 
|  | CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid | 
|  | bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side. | 
|  | It's no use iterating through the other commands.  */ | 
|  | } | 
|  | END_CATCH | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_cleanups); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We have a valid agent expression, return it.  */ | 
|  | return aexpr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be | 
|  | passed on to the target.  If we have duplicated locations with | 
|  | different commands, we will add any such to the list.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p; | 
|  | int null_command_or_parse_error = 0; | 
|  | int modified = bl->needs_update; | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Clear commands left over from a previous insert.  */ | 
|  | bl->target_info.tcommands.clear (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* For now, if we have any duplicate location that isn't a dprintf, | 
|  | don't install the target-side commands, as that would make the | 
|  | breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose | 
|  | control.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address) | 
|  | { | 
|  | loc = (*loc2p); | 
|  | if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) | 
|  | && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num | 
|  | && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned | 
|  | conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression | 
|  | bytecode.  If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions | 
|  | to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a | 
|  | response back to GDB.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address) | 
|  | { | 
|  | loc = (*loc2p); | 
|  | if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (modified) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Re-parse the commands since something changed.  In that | 
|  | case we already freed the command bytecodes (see | 
|  | force_breakpoint_reinsertion).  We just | 
|  | need to parse the command to bytecodes again.  */ | 
|  | loc->cmd_bytecode | 
|  | = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address, | 
|  | loc->owner->extra_string); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something | 
|  | went wrong or we have a null command expression.  */ | 
|  | if (!loc->cmd_bytecode) | 
|  | { | 
|  | null_command_or_parse_error = 1; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands, | 
|  | and so clean up.  */ | 
|  | if (null_command_or_parse_error) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address) | 
|  | { | 
|  | loc = (*loc2p); | 
|  | if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) | 
|  | && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is | 
|  | located.  */ | 
|  | if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | loc->cmd_bytecode.reset (); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation.  Build a command list | 
|  | for this location's address.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address) | 
|  | { | 
|  | loc = (*loc2p); | 
|  | if (loc->owner->extra_string | 
|  | && is_breakpoint (loc->owner) | 
|  | && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num | 
|  | && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled | 
|  | && loc->enabled) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Add the command to the vector.  This will be used later | 
|  | to send the commands to the target.  */ | 
|  | bl->target_info.tcommands.push_back (loc->cmd_bytecode.get ()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bl->target_info.persist = 0; | 
|  | /* Maybe flag this location as persistent.  */ | 
|  | if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf) | 
|  | bl->target_info.persist = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return the kind of breakpoint on address *ADDR.  Get the kind | 
|  | of breakpoint according to ADDR except single-step breakpoint. | 
|  | Get the kind of single-step breakpoint according to the current | 
|  | registers state.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_kind (struct bp_location *bl, CORE_ADDR *addr) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bl->owner->type == bp_single_step) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (bl->owner->thread); | 
|  | struct regcache *regcache; | 
|  |  | 
|  | regcache = get_thread_regcache (thr->ptid); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_current_state (bl->gdbarch, | 
|  | regcache, addr); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_pc (bl->gdbarch, addr); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type.  BL is the breakpoint | 
|  | location.  Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and | 
|  | DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems. | 
|  | Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or | 
|  | -1 for failure. | 
|  |  | 
|  | NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an | 
|  | object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type.  */ | 
|  | static int | 
|  | insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl, | 
|  | struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream, | 
|  | int *disabled_breaks, | 
|  | int *hw_breakpoint_error, | 
|  | int *hw_bp_error_explained_already) | 
|  | { | 
|  | enum errors bp_err = GDB_NO_ERROR; | 
|  | const char *bp_err_message = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out | 
|  | the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint | 
|  | is still inserted at that location.  This in turn breaks | 
|  | target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when | 
|  | a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location: | 
|  | Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that | 
|  | we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus | 
|  | read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in | 
|  | the breakpoint location's shadow contents.  */ | 
|  | bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address; | 
|  | bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace; | 
|  | bl->target_info.length = bl->length; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions | 
|  | for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not | 
|  | insert those locations.  With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target | 
|  | can decide when to stop and notify GDB.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | build_target_condition_list (bl); | 
|  | build_target_command_list (bl); | 
|  | /* Reset the modification marker.  */ | 
|  | bl->needs_update = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
|  | || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type | 
|  | is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see | 
|  | if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Two important cases are: | 
|  | - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory | 
|  | is readonly.  We change the type of the location to | 
|  | hardware breakpoint. | 
|  | - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is | 
|  | read-write.  This means we've previously made the | 
|  | location hardware one, but then the memory map changed, | 
|  | so we undo. | 
|  |  | 
|  | When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use | 
|  | location types we've just set here, the only possible | 
|  | problem is that memory map has changed during running | 
|  | program, but it's not going to work anyway with current | 
|  | gdb.  */ | 
|  | struct mem_region *mr | 
|  | = lookup_mem_region (bl->target_info.reqstd_address); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (mr) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints) | 
|  | { | 
|  | enum bp_loc_type new_type; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW) | 
|  | new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint; | 
|  | else | 
|  | new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (new_type != bl->loc_type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | static int said = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bl->loc_type = new_type; | 
|  | if (!said) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout, | 
|  | _("Note: automatically using " | 
|  | "hardware breakpoints for " | 
|  | "read-only addresses.\n")); | 
|  | said = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
|  | && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, | 
|  | _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n" | 
|  | "Cannot set software breakpoint " | 
|  | "at read-only address %s\n"), | 
|  | bl->owner->number, | 
|  | paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address)); | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay.  */ | 
|  | if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off | 
|  | || bl->section == NULL | 
|  | || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | TRY | 
|  | { | 
|  | int val; | 
|  |  | 
|  | val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl); | 
|  | if (val) | 
|  | bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR; | 
|  | } | 
|  | CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bp_err = e.error; | 
|  | bp_err_message = e.message; | 
|  | } | 
|  | END_CATCH | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section. | 
|  | Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA?  */ | 
|  | if (!overlay_events_enabled) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, | 
|  | so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA. | 
|  | This will not work for a hardware breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"), | 
|  | bl->owner->number); | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address, | 
|  | bl->section); | 
|  | /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA.  */ | 
|  | bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info; | 
|  | bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | TRY | 
|  | { | 
|  | int val; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bl->overlay_target_info.kind | 
|  | = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr); | 
|  | bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr; | 
|  | val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, | 
|  | &bl->overlay_target_info); | 
|  | if (val) | 
|  | bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR; | 
|  | } | 
|  | CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bp_err = e.error; | 
|  | bp_err_message = e.message; | 
|  | } | 
|  | END_CATCH | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bp_err != GDB_NO_ERROR) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, | 
|  | "Overlay breakpoint %d " | 
|  | "failed: in ROM?\n", | 
|  | bl->owner->number); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */ | 
|  | if (section_is_mapped (bl->section)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Yes.  This overlay section is mapped into memory.  */ | 
|  | TRY | 
|  | { | 
|  | int val; | 
|  |  | 
|  | val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl); | 
|  | if (val) | 
|  | bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR; | 
|  | } | 
|  | CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bp_err = e.error; | 
|  | bp_err_message = e.message; | 
|  | } | 
|  | END_CATCH | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* No.  This breakpoint will not be inserted. | 
|  | No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'.  */ | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bp_err != GDB_NO_ERROR) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Can't set the breakpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a | 
|  | breakpoint in a shared library that has already been | 
|  | removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload | 
|  | event.  Unfortunately, some targets that implement | 
|  | breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the | 
|  | breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target | 
|  | doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic | 
|  | errors as memory errors.  */ | 
|  | if ((bp_err == GENERIC_ERROR || bp_err == MEMORY_ERROR) | 
|  | && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
|  | && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address) | 
|  | || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace, | 
|  | bl->address))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs.  */ | 
|  | bl->shlib_disabled = 1; | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bl->owner); | 
|  | if (!*disabled_breaks) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, | 
|  | "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n", | 
|  | bl->owner->number); | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, | 
|  | "Temporarily disabling shared " | 
|  | "library breakpoints:\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | *disabled_breaks = 1; | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, | 
|  | "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number); | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | *hw_breakpoint_error = 1; | 
|  | *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_err_message != NULL; | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, | 
|  | "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s", | 
|  | bl->owner->number, bp_err_message ? ":" : ".\n"); | 
|  | if (bp_err_message != NULL) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n", bp_err_message); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bp_err_message == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *message | 
|  | = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO, | 
|  | bl->gdbarch, bl->address); | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, message); | 
|  |  | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, | 
|  | "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n" | 
|  | "%s\n", | 
|  | bl->owner->number, message); | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, | 
|  | "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n", | 
|  | bl->owner->number, | 
|  | bp_err_message); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | bl->inserted = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint | 
|  | /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing | 
|  | watchpoints.  It's not clear that it's necessary...  */ | 
|  | && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int val; | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL | 
|  | && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not | 
|  | supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint.  */ | 
|  | if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another | 
|  | hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate | 
|  | of this one.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp) | 
|  | if (loc != bl | 
|  | && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access | 
|  | && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bl->duplicate = 1; | 
|  | bl->inserted = 1; | 
|  | bl->target_info = loc->target_info; | 
|  | bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access; | 
|  | val = 0; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (val == 1) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access; | 
|  | val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (val) | 
|  | /* Back to the original value.  */ | 
|  | bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bl->inserted = (val == 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int val; | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL | 
|  | && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl); | 
|  | if (val) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (val == 1) | 
|  | warning (_("\ | 
|  | Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\ | 
|  | of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number); | 
|  | else | 
|  | warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bl->inserted = (val == 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem | 
|  | inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint, | 
|  | so just return success.  */ | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be | 
|  | deleted.  It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference | 
|  | PSPACE anymore.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp; | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b->pspace == pspace) | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations | 
|  | bound to PSPACE as well.  Remove those.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (loc->pspace == pspace) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL.  */ | 
|  | if (loc->owner->loc == loc) | 
|  | loc->owner->loc = loc->next; | 
|  | else | 
|  | for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next) | 
|  | if (tmp->next == loc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | tmp->next = loc->next; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the | 
|  | removed locations above.  */ | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior. | 
|  | Throws exception on any error. | 
|  | A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted | 
|  | again, so calling this function twice is safe.  */ | 
|  | void | 
|  | insert_breakpoints (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *bpt; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt) | 
|  | if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt; | 
|  |  | 
|  | update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse.  */); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global | 
|  | location list.  Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and | 
|  | ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode.  */ | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Invoke CALLBACK for each of bp_location.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | iterate_over_bp_locations (walk_bp_location_callback callback) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | callback (loc, NULL); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the | 
|  | target.  It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using | 
|  | always-inserted mode.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp; | 
|  | int error_flag = 0; | 
|  | int val = 0; | 
|  | int disabled_breaks = 0; | 
|  | int hw_breakpoint_error = 0; | 
|  | int hw_bp_details_reported = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen (); | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if | 
|  | there was an error.  */ | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | save_current_space_and_thread (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware | 
|  | breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted | 
|  | and need updating.  This is to avoid unwanted insertion during | 
|  | deletion of breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | if (!bl->inserted || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need | 
|  | to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to.  In fact, even | 
|  | if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still | 
|  | insert breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()) | 
|  | && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks, | 
|  | &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported); | 
|  | if (val) | 
|  | error_flag = val; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (error_flag) | 
|  | { | 
|  | target_terminal_ours_for_output (); | 
|  | error_stream (tmp_error_stream); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanups); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Used when starting or continuing the program.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | insert_breakpoint_locations (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *bpt; | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp; | 
|  | int error_flag = 0; | 
|  | int val = 0; | 
|  | int disabled_breaks = 0; | 
|  | int hw_breakpoint_error = 0; | 
|  | int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen (); | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if | 
|  | there was an error.  */ | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | save_current_space_and_thread (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if | 
|  | the thread no longer exists.  ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location | 
|  | has BL->OWNER always non-NULL.  */ | 
|  | if (bl->owner->thread != -1 | 
|  | && !valid_global_thread_id (bl->owner->thread)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need | 
|  | to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to.  In fact, even | 
|  | if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still | 
|  | insert breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()) | 
|  | && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks, | 
|  | &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already); | 
|  | if (val) | 
|  | error_flag = val; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove | 
|  | them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int some_failed = 0; | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next) | 
|  | if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | some_failed = 1; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (some_failed) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next) | 
|  | if (loc->inserted) | 
|  | remove_breakpoint (loc); | 
|  |  | 
|  | hw_breakpoint_error = 1; | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, | 
|  | "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n", | 
|  | bpt->number); | 
|  | error_flag = -1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (error_flag) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a | 
|  | message about possibly exhausted resources.  */ | 
|  | if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, | 
|  | "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\ | 
|  | You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | target_terminal_ours_for_output (); | 
|  | error_stream (tmp_error_stream); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanups); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Used when the program stops. | 
|  | Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem | 
|  | removing a breakpoint location.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | remove_breakpoints (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp; | 
|  | int val = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner)) | 
|  | val |= remove_breakpoint (bl); | 
|  | } | 
|  | return val; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to | 
|  | that thread.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b->thread == tp->global_num && user_breakpoint_p (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop; | 
|  |  | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("\ | 
|  | Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"), | 
|  | b->number, print_thread_id (tp)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Hide it from the user.  */ | 
|  | b->number = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Remove breakpoints of process PID.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp; | 
|  | int val; | 
|  | struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist) | 
|  | { | 
|  | val = remove_breakpoint (bl); | 
|  | if (val != 0) | 
|  | return val; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | reattach_breakpoints (int pid) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain; | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp; | 
|  | int val; | 
|  | struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream; | 
|  | int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0, dummy3 = 0; | 
|  | struct inferior *inf; | 
|  | struct thread_info *tp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid); | 
|  | if (tp == NULL) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | inf = find_inferior_pid (pid); | 
|  | old_chain = save_inferior_ptid (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | inferior_ptid = tp->ptid; | 
|  |  | 
|  | tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen (); | 
|  | make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bl->inserted) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bl->inserted = 0; | 
|  | val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &dummy1, &dummy2, &dummy3); | 
|  | if (val != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  | return val; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL. | 
|  | If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated | 
|  | from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented. | 
|  | Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from | 
|  | breakpoint_count and that value incremented.  Internal breakpoints | 
|  | do not set the internal var bpnum.  */ | 
|  | static void | 
|  | set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (internal) | 
|  | b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1); | 
|  | b->number = breakpoint_count; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct breakpoint * | 
|  | create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct symtab_and_line sal; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_sal (&sal);		/* Initialize to zeroes.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | sal.pc = address; | 
|  | sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc); | 
|  | sal.pspace = current_program_space; | 
|  |  | 
|  | b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops); | 
|  | b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--; | 
|  | b->disposition = disp_donttouch; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return b; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static const char *const longjmp_names[] = | 
|  | { | 
|  | "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp" | 
|  | }; | 
|  | #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names) | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c.  */ | 
|  | struct breakpoint_objfile_data | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any).  */ | 
|  | struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any).  */ | 
|  | struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes.  */ | 
|  | int longjmp_searched; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any).  */ | 
|  | VEC (probe_p) *longjmp_probes; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any).  */ | 
|  | struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any).  */ | 
|  | struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* True if we have looked for exception probes.  */ | 
|  | int exception_searched; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any).  */ | 
|  | VEC (probe_p) *exception_probes; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static const struct objfile_data *breakpoint_objfile_key; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel.  */ | 
|  | static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return msym == &msym_not_found; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c. | 
|  | Allocate the data if necessary.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct breakpoint_objfile_data * | 
|  | get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bp_objfile_data = ((struct breakpoint_objfile_data *) | 
|  | objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key)); | 
|  | if (bp_objfile_data == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bp_objfile_data = | 
|  | XOBNEW (&objfile->objfile_obstack, struct breakpoint_objfile_data); | 
|  |  | 
|  | memset (bp_objfile_data, 0, sizeof (*bp_objfile_data)); | 
|  | set_objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key, bp_objfile_data); | 
|  | } | 
|  | return bp_objfile_data; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | free_breakpoint_probes (struct objfile *obj, void *data) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data | 
|  | = (struct breakpoint_objfile_data *) data; | 
|  |  | 
|  | VEC_free (probe_p, bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes); | 
|  | VEC_free (probe_p, bp_objfile_data->exception_probes); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct objfile *objfile; | 
|  | const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event"; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_OBJFILES (objfile) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; | 
|  | CORE_ADDR addr; | 
|  | struct explicit_location explicit_loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bound_minimal_symbol m; | 
|  |  | 
|  | m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile); | 
|  | if (m.minsym == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile.  */ | 
|  | bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found; | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym); | 
|  | b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr, | 
|  | bp_overlay_event, | 
|  | &internal_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  | initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); | 
|  | explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name); | 
|  | b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto) | 
|  | { | 
|  | b->enable_state = bp_enabled; | 
|  | overlay_events_enabled = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
|  | overlay_events_enabled = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct program_space *pspace; | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain; | 
|  |  | 
|  | old_chain = save_current_program_space (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_PSPACES (pspace) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct objfile *objfile; | 
|  |  | 
|  | set_current_program_space (pspace); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_OBJFILES (objfile) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i; | 
|  | struct gdbarch *gdbarch; | 
|  | struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched) | 
|  | { | 
|  | VEC (probe_p) *ret; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ret = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp"); | 
|  | if (ret != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We are only interested in checking one element.  */ | 
|  | struct probe *p = VEC_index (probe_p, ret, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!can_evaluate_probe_arguments (p)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does | 
|  | not know how to evaluate arguments.  */ | 
|  | VEC_free (probe_p, ret); | 
|  | ret = NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret; | 
|  | bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i; | 
|  | struct probe *probe; | 
|  | struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0; | 
|  | VEC_iterate (probe_p, | 
|  | bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes, | 
|  | i, probe); | 
|  | ++i) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, | 
|  | get_probe_address (probe, | 
|  | objfile), | 
|  | bp_longjmp_master, | 
|  | &internal_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  | b->location | 
|  | = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp"); | 
|  | b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | const char *func_name; | 
|  | CORE_ADDR addr; | 
|  | struct explicit_location explicit_loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | func_name = longjmp_names[i]; | 
|  | if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bound_minimal_symbol m; | 
|  |  | 
|  | m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile); | 
|  | if (m.minsym == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile.  */ | 
|  | bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found; | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]); | 
|  | b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master, | 
|  | &internal_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  | initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); | 
|  | explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name); | 
|  | b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); | 
|  | b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | static void | 
|  | create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct program_space *pspace; | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain; | 
|  | const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()"; | 
|  |  | 
|  | old_chain = save_current_program_space (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_PSPACES (pspace) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct objfile *objfile; | 
|  | CORE_ADDR addr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | set_current_program_space (pspace); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_OBJFILES (objfile) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; | 
|  | struct explicit_location explicit_loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bound_minimal_symbol m; | 
|  |  | 
|  | m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile); | 
|  | if (m.minsym == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_text | 
|  | && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_file_text)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile.  */ | 
|  | bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found; | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym); | 
|  | b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr, | 
|  | bp_std_terminate_master, | 
|  | &internal_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  | initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); | 
|  | explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name); | 
|  | b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); | 
|  | b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | create_exception_master_breakpoint (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct objfile *objfile; | 
|  | const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook"; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_OBJFILES (objfile) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | struct gdbarch *gdbarch; | 
|  | struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; | 
|  | CORE_ADDR addr; | 
|  | struct explicit_location explicit_loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists.  */ | 
|  | if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched) | 
|  | { | 
|  | VEC (probe_p) *ret; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ret = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (ret != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We are only interested in checking one element.  */ | 
|  | struct probe *p = VEC_index (probe_p, ret, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!can_evaluate_probe_arguments (p)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does | 
|  | not know how to evaluate arguments.  */ | 
|  | VEC_free (probe_p, ret); | 
|  | ret = NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret; | 
|  | bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bp_objfile_data->exception_probes != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile); | 
|  | int i; | 
|  | struct probe *probe; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0; | 
|  | VEC_iterate (probe_p, | 
|  | bp_objfile_data->exception_probes, | 
|  | i, probe); | 
|  | ++i) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, | 
|  | get_probe_address (probe, | 
|  | objfile), | 
|  | bp_exception_master, | 
|  | &internal_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  | b->location | 
|  | = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind"); | 
|  | b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Otherwise, try the hook function.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook; | 
|  |  | 
|  | debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile); | 
|  | if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found; | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym); | 
|  | addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr, | 
|  | ¤t_target); | 
|  | b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master, | 
|  | &internal_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  | initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); | 
|  | explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name); | 
|  | b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); | 
|  | b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Does B have a location spec?  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (const struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return b->location != NULL && event_location_empty_p (b->location); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | update_breakpoints_after_exec (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp; | 
|  | struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists.  If the | 
|  | INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by | 
|  | writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory.  The | 
|  | "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not | 
|  | do that.  Instead, the target is responsible from marking | 
|  | breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec.  We don't do that | 
|  | here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete | 
|  | breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp) | 
|  | if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space) | 
|  | gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b->pspace != current_program_space) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec().  */ | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_shlib_event) | 
|  | { | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec().  */ | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_jit_event) | 
|  | { | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(), | 
|  | as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event | 
|  | || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master | 
|  | || b->type == bp_exception_master) | 
|  | { | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec().  */ | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume) | 
|  | { | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Just like single-step breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_single_step) | 
|  | { | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless | 
|  | after an exec.  */ | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume | 
|  | || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy | 
|  | || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume) | 
|  | { | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_catchpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to | 
|  | do anything at this point.  In the future, if some of | 
|  | the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add | 
|  | a new method, and call this method from here.  */ | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* bp_finish is a special case.  The only way we ought to be able | 
|  | to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user | 
|  | caught a vfork, and then said "finish".  Ordinarily a finish just | 
|  | carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting | 
|  | a temporary bp there and resuming.  But in this case, the finish | 
|  | will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec. | 
|  |  | 
|  | We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now.  But | 
|  | we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to | 
|  | the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it.  There's a | 
|  | chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish | 
|  | here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command | 
|  | gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint. | 
|  | We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish. | 
|  |  | 
|  | In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know | 
|  | it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?" | 
|  | problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and | 
|  | let finish_command delete it. | 
|  |  | 
|  | (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's | 
|  | momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees | 
|  | the inferior stopped.  So it doesn't matter that the bp's | 
|  | address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the | 
|  | solib breakpoints.)  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_finish) | 
|  | { | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the | 
|  | pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec() | 
|  | a.out.  */ | 
|  | if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp; | 
|  | int val = 0; | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid (); | 
|  | struct inferior *inf = current_inferior (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (ptid_get_pid (ptid) == ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid)) | 
|  | error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global.  */ | 
|  | inferior_ptid = ptid; | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations | 
|  | from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint | 
|  | package's state.  Locations of type bp_loc_other are only | 
|  | maintained at GDB side.  So, there is no need to remove | 
|  | these bp_loc_other locations.  Moreover, removing these | 
|  | would modify the breakpoint package's state.  */ | 
|  | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bl->inserted) | 
|  | val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, DETACH_BREAKPOINT); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  | return val; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space. | 
|  | Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork. | 
|  | When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither | 
|  | do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should | 
|  | *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int val; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers.  */ | 
|  | gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted. | 
|  | This should not ever happen.  */ | 
|  | gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
|  | || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard | 
|  | trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a | 
|  | bp_hardware_breakpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay.  */ | 
|  | if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off | 
|  | || bl->section == NULL | 
|  | || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we | 
|  | know is set in a dynamic object that is marked | 
|  | shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was | 
|  | removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with | 
|  | "nosharedlibrary".  In the former case, we don't know | 
|  | whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the | 
|  | breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know | 
|  | about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of | 
|  | add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a | 
|  | list of dynamically loaded objects).  If we have the | 
|  | breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software | 
|  | breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint | 
|  | is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong | 
|  | code with stale saved shadow contents.  Note that HW | 
|  | breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're | 
|  | implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on | 
|  | being able to modify the target's memory, and as such | 
|  | they should always be removed.  */ | 
|  | if (bl->shlib_disabled | 
|  | && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0 | 
|  | && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info)) | 
|  | val = 0; | 
|  | else | 
|  | val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section. | 
|  | Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA?  */ | 
|  | if (!overlay_events_enabled) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we | 
|  | should have set a breakpoint at the LMA.  Remove it. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will | 
|  | have already warned when we failed to insert it.  */ | 
|  | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, | 
|  | &bl->overlay_target_info); | 
|  | else | 
|  | target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, | 
|  | &bl->overlay_target_info, | 
|  | reason); | 
|  | } | 
|  | /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA? | 
|  | If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'.  */ | 
|  | if (bl->inserted) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Yes -- remove it.  Previously we did not bother to | 
|  | remove the breakpoint if the section had been | 
|  | unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe.  We | 
|  | don't know what the overlay manager might do.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only | 
|  | if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite | 
|  | wrong code with the saved shadow contents.  */ | 
|  | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint | 
|  | || section_is_mapped (bl->section)) | 
|  | val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason); | 
|  | else | 
|  | val = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove.  No error.  */ | 
|  | val = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in | 
|  | a shared library that has already been removed, but we have | 
|  | not yet processed the shlib unload event.  Similarly for an | 
|  | unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have | 
|  | had the chance to remove-symbol-file it.  shlib_disabled will | 
|  | be set if the library/object has already been removed, but | 
|  | the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after | 
|  | "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints | 
|  | always-inserted mode.  */ | 
|  | if (val | 
|  | && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
|  | && (bl->shlib_disabled | 
|  | || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address) | 
|  | || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace, | 
|  | bl->address)))) | 
|  | val = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (val) | 
|  | return val; | 
|  | bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL | 
|  | && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT); | 
|  | bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here.  */ | 
|  | if (reason == REMOVE_BREAKPOINT && bl->inserted) | 
|  | warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."), | 
|  | bl->owner->number); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint | 
|  | && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner) | 
|  | && !bl->duplicate) | 
|  | { | 
|  | gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL | 
|  | && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason); | 
|  | if (val) | 
|  | return val; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int ret; | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers.  */ | 
|  | gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted. | 
|  | This should not ever happen.  */ | 
|  | gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none); | 
|  |  | 
|  | old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT); | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  | return ret; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | mark_breakpoints_out (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp) | 
|  | if (bl->pspace == current_program_space) | 
|  | bl->inserted = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any | 
|  | breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints | 
|  | between runs. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by | 
|  | generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by | 
|  | init_wait_for_inferior).  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp; | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl; | 
|  | int ix; | 
|  | struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's | 
|  | nothing to do.  */ | 
|  | if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | mark_breakpoints_out (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (b->type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case bp_call_dummy: | 
|  | case bp_longjmp_call_dummy: | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will | 
|  | cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get | 
|  | rid of it.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bp_watchpoint_scope: | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bp_shlib_event: | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Also remove solib event breakpoints.  Their addresses may | 
|  | have changed since the last time we ran the program. | 
|  | Actually we may now be debugging against different target; | 
|  | and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may | 
|  | not be used in by the target.  E.g., | 
|  |  | 
|  | (gdb) file prog-linux | 
|  | (gdb) run               # native linux target | 
|  | ... | 
|  | (gdb) kill | 
|  | (gdb) file prog-win.exe | 
|  | (gdb) tar rem :9999     # remote Windows gdbserver. | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bp_step_resume: | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bp_single_step: | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Also remove single-step breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bp_watchpoint: | 
|  | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
|  | case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
|  | case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions.  */ | 
|  | if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL) | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer | 
|  | valid.  New ones will be created in | 
|  | update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted. | 
|  | The next update_global_location_list call will | 
|  | garbage collect them.  */ | 
|  | b->loc = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (context == inf_starting) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in | 
|  | insert_breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | if (w->val) | 
|  | value_free (w->val); | 
|  | w->val = NULL; | 
|  | w->val_valid = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Get rid of the moribund locations.  */ | 
|  | for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bl); ++ix) | 
|  | decref_bp_location (&bl); | 
|  | VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the | 
|  | target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if | 
|  | we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space | 
|  | match, not program space.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint | 
|  | exists at PC.  It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an | 
|  | ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a | 
|  | permanent breakpoint. | 
|  | - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we | 
|  | actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints. | 
|  | - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we | 
|  | need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by | 
|  | the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | enum breakpoint_here | 
|  | breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp; | 
|  | int any_breakpoint_here = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
|  | && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL.  */ | 
|  | if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner) | 
|  | || bl->permanent) | 
|  | && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (overlay_debugging | 
|  | && section_is_overlay (bl->section) | 
|  | && !section_is_mapped (bl->section)) | 
|  | continue;		/* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */ | 
|  | else if (bl->permanent) | 
|  | return permanent_breakpoint_here; | 
|  | else | 
|  | any_breakpoint_here = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | breakpoint_in_range_p (struct address_space *aspace, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
|  | && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner) | 
|  | || bl->permanent) | 
|  | && breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl, aspace, | 
|  | addr, len)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (overlay_debugging | 
|  | && section_is_overlay (bl->section) | 
|  | && !section_is_mapped (bl->section)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match.  */ | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  | int ix; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix) | 
|  | if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc)) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space | 
|  | ASPACE.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location *bl, | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bl->inserted | 
|  | && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address, | 
|  | aspace, pc)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (overlay_debugging | 
|  | && section_is_overlay (bl->section) | 
|  | && !section_is_mapped (bl->section)) | 
|  | return 0;		/* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */ | 
|  | else | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl = *blp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
|  | && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc)) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint | 
|  | inserted at PC.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR pc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl = *blp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc)) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR pc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl = *blp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc)) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *bpt; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint | 
|  | && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next) | 
|  | if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted) | 
|  | { | 
|  | CORE_ADDR l, h; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check for intersection.  */ | 
|  | l = std::max<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address, addr); | 
|  | h = std::min<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len); | 
|  | if (l < h) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* bpstat stuff.  External routines' interfaces are documented | 
|  | in breakpoint.h.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat.  Does not walk the | 
|  | 'next' chain.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | bpstat_free (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bs->old_val != NULL) | 
|  | value_free (bs->old_val); | 
|  | decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands); | 
|  | decref_bp_location (&bs->bp_location_at); | 
|  | xfree (bs); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint. | 
|  | Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bpstat p; | 
|  | bpstat q; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bsp == 0) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | p = *bsp; | 
|  | while (p != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | q = p->next; | 
|  | bpstat_free (p); | 
|  | p = q; | 
|  | } | 
|  | *bsp = NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return a copy of a bpstat.  Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that | 
|  | is part of the bpstat is copied as well.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | bpstat | 
|  | bpstat_copy (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bpstat p = NULL; | 
|  | bpstat tmp; | 
|  | bpstat retval = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bs == NULL) | 
|  | return bs; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp)); | 
|  | memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp)); | 
|  | incref_counted_command_line (tmp->commands); | 
|  | incref_bp_location (tmp->bp_location_at); | 
|  | if (bs->old_val != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val); | 
|  | release_value (tmp->old_val); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (p == NULL) | 
|  | /* This is the first thing in the chain.  */ | 
|  | retval = tmp; | 
|  | else | 
|  | p->next = tmp; | 
|  | p = tmp; | 
|  | } | 
|  | p->next = NULL; | 
|  | return retval; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | bpstat | 
|  | bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bsp == NULL) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint) | 
|  | return bsp; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp, enum gdb_signal sig) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than | 
|  | GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP.  */ | 
|  | if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at, | 
|  | sig)) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are | 
|  | stopped at.  *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the | 
|  | remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be | 
|  | good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num). | 
|  |  | 
|  | Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints. | 
|  | Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since | 
|  | we set it. | 
|  | Return 1 otherwise.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((*bsp) == NULL) | 
|  | return 0;			/* No more breakpoint values */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a | 
|  | single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the | 
|  | same number more than once and this will look ugly.  */ | 
|  | b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at; | 
|  | *bsp = (*bsp)->next; | 
|  | if (b == NULL) | 
|  | return -1;			/* breakpoint that's been deleted since */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | *num = b->number;		/* We have its number */ | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | bpstat_clear_actions (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct thread_info *tp; | 
|  | bpstat bs; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | tp = find_thread_ptid (inferior_ptid); | 
|  | if (tp == NULL) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bs->old_val != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | value_free (bs->old_val); | 
|  | bs->old_val = NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not | 
|  | interrupt the command list.  When the call finishes | 
|  | successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same | 
|  | breakpoint as if nothing happened.  */ | 
|  | if (tp->control.in_infcall) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | breakpoint_proceeded = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint | 
|  | command.  */ | 
|  | static void | 
|  | cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore) | 
|  | { | 
|  | executing_breakpoint_commands = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent' | 
|  | or its equivalent.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at | 
|  | this location.  Any of these commands could cause the process to | 
|  | proceed beyond this point, etc.  We look out for such changes by | 
|  | checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior.  In that | 
|  | case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the | 
|  | bpstat of the current thread.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bpstat bs; | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain; | 
|  | int again = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained | 
|  | in bs->commands.  */ | 
|  | if (executing_breakpoint_commands) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | executing_breakpoint_commands = 1; | 
|  | old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | prevent_dont_repeat (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's.  */ | 
|  | bs = *bsp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | breakpoint_proceeded = 0; | 
|  | for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct counted_command_line *ccmd; | 
|  | struct command_line *cmd; | 
|  | struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one. | 
|  |  | 
|  | The command tree could legitimately contain commands like | 
|  | 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which | 
|  | frees stop_bpstat's command tree.  To make sure this doesn't | 
|  | free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to | 
|  | take ownership of the tree ourselves.  Since a given bpstat's | 
|  | commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we | 
|  | can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free | 
|  | the tree when we're done.  */ | 
|  | ccmd = bs->commands; | 
|  | bs->commands = NULL; | 
|  | this_cmd_tree_chain = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&ccmd); | 
|  | cmd = ccmd ? ccmd->commands : NULL; | 
|  | if (command_line_is_silent (cmd)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status.  */ | 
|  | cmd = cmd->next; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | while (cmd != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | execute_control_command (cmd); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (breakpoint_proceeded) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | else | 
|  | cmd = cmd->next; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We can free this command tree now.  */ | 
|  | do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (breakpoint_proceeded) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (current_ui->async) | 
|  | /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still | 
|  | running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for | 
|  | us to do here -- just return to the event loop.  */ | 
|  | ; | 
|  | else | 
|  | /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns | 
|  | we're already standing on the next breakpoint. | 
|  | Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since | 
|  | execute_command does not run breakpoint commands -- | 
|  | only command_line_handler does, but that one is not | 
|  | involved in execution of breakpoint commands.  So, we | 
|  | can now execute breakpoint commands.  It should be | 
|  | noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is | 
|  | not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive | 
|  | invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a | 
|  | command, and can easily blow up GDB stack.  Instead, we | 
|  | return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us | 
|  | with the new stop_bpstat.  */ | 
|  | again = 1; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  | return again; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | bpstat_do_actions (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanup_if_error = make_bpstat_clear_actions_cleanup (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at.  */ | 
|  | while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid) | 
|  | && target_has_execution | 
|  | && !is_exited (inferior_ptid) | 
|  | && !is_executing (inferior_ptid)) | 
|  | /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior, | 
|  | and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we | 
|  | keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to | 
|  | indicate the inferior was not resumed.  */ | 
|  | if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->control.stop_bpstat)) | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | discard_cleanups (cleanup_if_error); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (val == NULL) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>")); | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct value_print_options opts; | 
|  | get_user_print_options (&opts); | 
|  | value_print (val, stream, &opts); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if | 
|  | debugging multiple threads.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out *uiout) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | uiout->text ("\n"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ()) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *name; | 
|  | struct thread_info *thr = inferior_thread (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | uiout->text ("Thread "); | 
|  | uiout->field_fmt ("thread-id", "%s", print_thread_id (thr)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | name = thr->name != NULL ? thr->name : target_thread_name (thr); | 
|  | if (name != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | uiout->text (" \""); | 
|  | uiout->field_fmt ("name", "%s", name); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\""); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | uiout->text (" hit "); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we | 
|  | stopped.  The behavior of this function depends on the value | 
|  | 'print_it' in the bpstat structure.  Under some circumstances we | 
|  | may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to | 
|  | normal_stop().  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum print_stop_action | 
|  | print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch (bs->print_it) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case print_it_noop: | 
|  | /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry.  */ | 
|  | return PRINT_UNKNOWN; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case print_it_done: | 
|  | /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the | 
|  | relevant messages.  */ | 
|  | return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case print_it_normal: | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint | 
|  | which has since been deleted.  */ | 
|  | if (b == NULL) | 
|  | return PRINT_UNKNOWN; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Normal case.  Call the breakpoint's print_it method.  */ | 
|  | return b->ops->print_it (bs); | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | default: | 
|  | internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, | 
|  | _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value")); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int any_deleted | 
|  | = !VEC_empty (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs); | 
|  | int any_added | 
|  | = !VEC_empty (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!is_catchpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (any_added || any_deleted) | 
|  | current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event:\n")); | 
|  | else | 
|  | current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event (no " | 
|  | "libraries added or removed)\n")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | current_uiout->field_string ("reason", | 
|  | async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (any_deleted) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanup; | 
|  | char *name; | 
|  | int ix; | 
|  |  | 
|  | current_uiout->text (_("  Inferior unloaded ")); | 
|  | cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (current_uiout, | 
|  | "removed"); | 
|  | for (ix = 0; | 
|  | VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs, | 
|  | ix, name); | 
|  | ++ix) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (ix > 0) | 
|  | current_uiout->text ("    "); | 
|  | current_uiout->field_string ("library", name); | 
|  | current_uiout->text ("\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanup); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (any_added) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct so_list *iter; | 
|  | int ix; | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanup; | 
|  |  | 
|  | current_uiout->text (_("  Inferior loaded ")); | 
|  | cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (current_uiout, | 
|  | "added"); | 
|  | for (ix = 0; | 
|  | VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs, | 
|  | ix, iter); | 
|  | ++ix) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (ix > 0) | 
|  | current_uiout->text ("    "); | 
|  | current_uiout->field_string ("library", iter->so_name); | 
|  | current_uiout->text ("\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanup); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print a message indicating what happened.  This is called from | 
|  | normal_stop().  The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat | 
|  | list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop.  KIND is | 
|  | the target_waitkind for the stopping event.  This | 
|  | routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message | 
|  | about reasons for stopping.  This will print (for example) the | 
|  | "Breakpoint n," part of the output.  The return value of this | 
|  | routine is one of: | 
|  |  | 
|  | PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing. | 
|  | PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent | 
|  | code to print the location.  An example is | 
|  | "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by | 
|  | the location. | 
|  | PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need | 
|  | to also print the location part of the message. | 
|  | An example is the catch/throw messages, which | 
|  | don't require a location appended to the end. | 
|  | PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any | 
|  | further info to be printed.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | enum print_stop_action | 
|  | bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind) | 
|  | { | 
|  | enum print_stop_action val; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop. | 
|  | (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not. | 
|  | That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken | 
|  | with respect to bpstat_explains_signal).  */ | 
|  | for (; bs; bs = bs->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | val = print_bp_stop_message (bs); | 
|  | if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY | 
|  | || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC | 
|  | || val == PRINT_NOTHING) | 
|  | return val; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint, | 
|  | print_bp_stop_message would print out this message.  If we hit an | 
|  | OS-level shared library event, do the same thing.  */ | 
|  | if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED) | 
|  | { | 
|  | print_solib_event (0); | 
|  | return PRINT_NOTHING; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start | 
|  | with and nothing was printed.  */ | 
|  | return PRINT_UNKNOWN; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero. | 
|  | This returns the inverse of the condition because it is called | 
|  | from catch_errors which returns 0 if an exception happened, and if an | 
|  | exception happens we want execution to stop. | 
|  | The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to a | 
|  | "void *" to make it pass through catch_errors.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct value *mark = value_mark (); | 
|  | int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | value_free_to_mark (mark); | 
|  | return i; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Allocate a new bpstat.  Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bpstat | 
|  | bpstat_alloc (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bpstat bs; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs)); | 
|  | bs->next = NULL; | 
|  | **bs_link_pointer = bs; | 
|  | *bs_link_pointer = &bs->next; | 
|  | bs->breakpoint_at = bl->owner; | 
|  | bs->bp_location_at = bl; | 
|  | incref_bp_location (bl); | 
|  | /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands.  */ | 
|  | bs->commands = NULL; | 
|  | bs->old_val = NULL; | 
|  | bs->print_it = print_it_normal; | 
|  | return bs; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS.  Check if any hardware | 
|  | watchpoints have triggered, according to the target.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint (); | 
|  | CORE_ADDR addr; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!stopped_by_watchpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint.  Mark all watchpoints | 
|  | as not triggered.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!target_stopped_data_address (¤t_target, &addr)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where. | 
|  | Mark all watchpoints as unknown.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The target could report the data address.  Mark watchpoints | 
|  | affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not | 
|  | triggered.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no; | 
|  | for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (is_masked_watchpoint (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask; | 
|  | CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (newaddr == start) | 
|  | { | 
|  | w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | /* Exact match not required.  Within range is sufficient.  */ | 
|  | else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (¤t_target, | 
|  | addr, loc->address, | 
|  | loc->length)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum | 
|  | because of check_errors).  */ | 
|  | /* The watchpoint has been deleted.  */ | 
|  | #define WP_DELETED 1 | 
|  | /* The value has changed.  */ | 
|  | #define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2 | 
|  | /* The value has not changed.  */ | 
|  | #define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3 | 
|  | /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not.  */ | 
|  | #define WP_IGNORE 4 | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1 | 
|  | #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2 | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value | 
|  | changed. | 
|  |  | 
|  | P should be a pointer to struct bpstat, but is defined as a void * | 
|  | in order for this function to be usable with catch_errors.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | watchpoint_check (void *p) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bpstat bs = (bpstat) p; | 
|  | struct watchpoint *b; | 
|  | struct frame_info *fr; | 
|  | int within_current_scope; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL); | 
|  | b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the | 
|  | watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread | 
|  | that was used to create the watchpoint.  */ | 
|  | if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b)) | 
|  | return WP_IGNORE; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL) | 
|  | within_current_scope = 1; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame (); | 
|  | struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame); | 
|  | CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're | 
|  | still in the function but the stack frame has already been | 
|  | invalidated.  Since we can't rely on the values of local | 
|  | variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating | 
|  | the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further | 
|  | checking.  Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current | 
|  | frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other | 
|  | frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and | 
|  | frame_find_by_id could error out.  */ | 
|  | if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc)) | 
|  | return WP_IGNORE; | 
|  |  | 
|  | fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame); | 
|  | within_current_scope = (fr != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have | 
|  | returned a frame that can't describe this variable.  */ | 
|  | if (within_current_scope) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct symbol *function; | 
|  |  | 
|  | function = get_frame_function (fr); | 
|  | if (function == NULL | 
|  | || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block, | 
|  | SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function))) | 
|  | within_current_scope = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (within_current_scope) | 
|  | /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected | 
|  | in normal_stop.  So this call to select_frame won't affect | 
|  | the user.  */ | 
|  | select_frame (fr); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (within_current_scope) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long* | 
|  | time before we return to the command level and call | 
|  | free_all_values.  We can't call free_all_values because we | 
|  | might be in the middle of evaluating a function call.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int pc = 0; | 
|  | struct value *mark; | 
|  | struct value *new_val; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (is_masked_watchpoint (&b->base)) | 
|  | /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from | 
|  | stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered | 
|  | a mask watchpoint.  */ | 
|  | return WP_VALUE_CHANGED; | 
|  |  | 
|  | mark = value_mark (); | 
|  | fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (b->val_bitsize != 0) | 
|  | new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because | 
|  | the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just | 
|  | the address of the array instead of its contents.  This is | 
|  | not what we want.  */ | 
|  | if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL) | 
|  | || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (new_val != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | release_value (new_val); | 
|  | value_free_to_mark (mark); | 
|  | } | 
|  | bs->old_val = b->val; | 
|  | b->val = new_val; | 
|  | b->val_valid = 1; | 
|  | return WP_VALUE_CHANGED; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Nothing changed.  */ | 
|  | value_free_to_mark (mark); | 
|  | return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because | 
|  | if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when | 
|  | we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains | 
|  | garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two | 
|  | garbage values, one before and one after the prologue). | 
|  | So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and | 
|  | watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal | 
|  | the first value assigned).  */ | 
|  | /* We print all the stop information in | 
|  | breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we | 
|  | call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted | 
|  | already.  So we have no choice but print the information | 
|  | here.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS () | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | uiout->field_string | 
|  | ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE)); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\nWatchpoint "); | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("wpnum", b->base.number); | 
|  | uiout->text (" deleted because the program has left the block in\n" | 
|  | "which its expression is valid.\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed.  */ | 
|  | decref_counted_command_line (&b->base.commands); | 
|  | watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return WP_DELETED; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting | 
|  | breakpoint location BL.  This function does not check if we should | 
|  | stop, only if BL explains the stop.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
|  | const struct target_waitstatus *ws) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* BL is from an existing breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | gdb_assert (b != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we | 
|  | should stop.  If not, set BS->stop to 0.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const struct bp_location *bl; | 
|  | struct watchpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | bl = bs->bp_location_at; | 
|  | gdb_assert (bl != NULL); | 
|  | b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at; | 
|  | gdb_assert (b != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | { | 
|  | int must_check_value = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint) | 
|  | /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the | 
|  | watched value.  */ | 
|  | must_check_value = 1; | 
|  | else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes) | 
|  | /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access) | 
|  | and the target earlier reported an address watched by | 
|  | this watchpoint.  */ | 
|  | must_check_value = 1; | 
|  | else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown | 
|  | && b->base.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint) | 
|  | /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could | 
|  | not report the data address.  We must check the watchpoint's | 
|  | value.  Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without | 
|  | a data address, we can't figure it out.  */ | 
|  | must_check_value = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (must_check_value) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *message | 
|  | = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n", | 
|  | b->base.number); | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message); | 
|  | int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message, | 
|  | RETURN_MASK_ALL); | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanups); | 
|  | switch (e) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case WP_DELETED: | 
|  | /* We've already printed what needs to be printed.  */ | 
|  | bs->print_it = print_it_done; | 
|  | /* Stop.  */ | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case WP_IGNORE: | 
|  | bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | 
|  | bs->stop = 0; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case WP_VALUE_CHANGED: | 
|  | if (b->base.type == bp_read_watchpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* There are two cases to consider here: | 
|  |  | 
|  | 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads. | 
|  | In that case, trust the target, and always report | 
|  | the watchpoint hit to the user.  Even though | 
|  | reads don't cause value changes, the value may | 
|  | have changed since the last time it was read, and | 
|  | since we're not trapping writes, we will not see | 
|  | those, and as such we should ignore our notion of | 
|  | old value. | 
|  |  | 
|  | 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both | 
|  | reads and writes.  There are two ways this may | 
|  | happen: | 
|  |  | 
|  | 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data | 
|  | reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or | 
|  | writes), such as e.g., x86.  We detect this case | 
|  | at the time we try to insert read watchpoints. | 
|  |  | 
|  | 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read | 
|  | watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write | 
|  | watchpoint watching the same memory as this read | 
|  | watchpoint. | 
|  |  | 
|  | If we're watching memory writes as well as reads, | 
|  | ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the | 
|  | value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause | 
|  | changes.  This still gives false positives when | 
|  | the program writes the same value to memory as | 
|  | what there was already in memory (we will confuse | 
|  | it for a read), but it's much better than | 
|  | nothing.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int other_write_watchpoint = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *other_b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b) | 
|  | if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint | 
|  | || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *other_w = | 
|  | (struct watchpoint *) other_b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered | 
|  | == watch_triggered_yes) | 
|  | { | 
|  | other_write_watchpoint = 1; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (other_write_watchpoint | 
|  | || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We're watching the same memory for writes, | 
|  | and the value changed since the last time we | 
|  | updated it, so this trap must be for a write. | 
|  | Ignore it.  */ | 
|  | bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | 
|  | bs->stop = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED: | 
|  | if (b->base.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint | 
|  | || b->base.type == bp_watchpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if | 
|  | the value hasn't changed.  */ | 
|  | bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | 
|  | bs->stop = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | /* Stop.  */ | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | /* Can't happen.  */ | 
|  | case 0: | 
|  | /* Error from catch_errors.  */ | 
|  | { | 
|  | SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS () | 
|  | { | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), | 
|  | b->base.number); | 
|  | } | 
|  | watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b); | 
|  | /* We've already printed what needs to be printed.  */ | 
|  | bs->print_it = print_it_done; | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else	/* must_check_value == 0 */ | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but | 
|  | not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no | 
|  | watchpoint triggered after all.  So don't print | 
|  | anything for this watchpoint.  */ | 
|  | bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | 
|  | bs->stop = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop, | 
|  | check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count) | 
|  | of breakpoint referred to by BS.  If we should not stop for this | 
|  | breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const struct bp_location *bl; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | int value_is_zero = 0; | 
|  | struct expression *cond; | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (bs->stop); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | bl = bs->bp_location_at; | 
|  | gdb_assert (bl != NULL); | 
|  | b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
|  | gdb_assert (b != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we | 
|  | need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a | 
|  | breakpoint or a single step breakpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id) | 
|  | && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ()))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bs->stop = 0; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu | 
|  | evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified | 
|  | thread/task.  */ | 
|  | if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != ptid_to_global_thread_id (ptid)) | 
|  | || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (ptid))) | 
|  |  | 
|  | { | 
|  | bs->stop = 0; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method | 
|  | implemented.  */ | 
|  | bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (is_watchpoint (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | cond = w->cond_exp.get (); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | cond = bl->cond.get (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int within_current_scope = 1; | 
|  | struct watchpoint * w; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could | 
|  | be a long time before we return to the command level and | 
|  | call free_all_values.  We can't call free_all_values | 
|  | because we might be in the middle of evaluating a | 
|  | function call.  */ | 
|  | struct value *mark = value_mark (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (is_watchpoint (b)) | 
|  | w = (struct watchpoint *) b; | 
|  | else | 
|  | w = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that | 
|  | the conditions will have the right context.  Because we | 
|  | use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's | 
|  | variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start | 
|  | of the inlined function; the current frame will be the | 
|  | call site.  */ | 
|  | if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL) | 
|  | select_frame (get_current_frame ()); | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct frame_info *frame; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular | 
|  | instance of a local is being watched matters, so we | 
|  | keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression | 
|  | in.  To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't | 
|  | really matter which instantiation of the function | 
|  | where the condition makes sense triggers the | 
|  | watchpoint.  This allows an expression like "watch | 
|  | global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to | 
|  | global on all threads that call `func', or catch | 
|  | writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single | 
|  | thread.  We simply always evaluate the condition in | 
|  | the innermost frame that's executing where it makes | 
|  | sense to evaluate the condition.  It seems | 
|  | intuitive.  */ | 
|  | frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block); | 
|  | if (frame != NULL) | 
|  | select_frame (frame); | 
|  | else | 
|  | within_current_scope = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (within_current_scope) | 
|  | value_is_zero | 
|  | = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, cond, | 
|  | "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n", | 
|  | RETURN_MASK_ALL); | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested " | 
|  | "in the current scope")); | 
|  | /* If we failed to set the right context for this | 
|  | watchpoint, unconditionally report it.  */ | 
|  | value_is_zero = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #.  */ | 
|  | value_free_to_mark (mark); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (cond && value_is_zero) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bs->stop = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (b->ignore_count > 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | b->ignore_count--; | 
|  | bs->stop = 0; | 
|  | /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop.  */ | 
|  | ++(b->hit_count); | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type | 
|  | on the current target.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location *loc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | 
|  | && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()) | 
|  | || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint | 
|  | && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address | 
|  | BP_ADDR in thread PTID. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we | 
|  | don't understand this stop.  Result is a chain of bpstat's such | 
|  | that: | 
|  |  | 
|  | if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer. | 
|  |  | 
|  | if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or | 
|  | watchpoint at which we have stopped.  (We may have stopped for | 
|  | several reasons concurrently.) | 
|  |  | 
|  | Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at, | 
|  | commands, FIXME??? fields.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | bpstat | 
|  | bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid, | 
|  | const struct target_waitstatus *ws) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = NULL; | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl; | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  | /* First item of allocated bpstat's.  */ | 
|  | bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head; | 
|  | /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently.  */ | 
|  | bpstat bs; | 
|  | int ix; | 
|  | int need_remove_insert; | 
|  | int removed_any; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a | 
|  | target stop, while being careful to not set the target running, | 
|  | as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint | 
|  | locations are recreated).  Resuming will happen here with | 
|  | breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include | 
|  | inferior function calls.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!breakpoint_enabled (b)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first | 
|  | location.  The watchpoint_check function will work on the | 
|  | entire expression, not the individual locations.  For | 
|  | read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has | 
|  | checked all locations already.  */ | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc) | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address | 
|  | matches.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, &bs_link);	/* Alloc a bpstat to | 
|  | explain stop.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Assume we stop.  Should we find a watchpoint that is not | 
|  | actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint | 
|  | evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0.  */ | 
|  | bs->stop = 1; | 
|  | bs->print = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated | 
|  | watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the | 
|  | out-of-scope event.  We'll get to the watchpoint next | 
|  | iteration.  */ | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint; | 
|  |  | 
|  | w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop.  */ | 
|  | if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint () | 
|  | || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr) | 
|  | && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, &bs_link); | 
|  | /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed.  */ | 
|  | bs->stop = 0; | 
|  | bs->print = 0; | 
|  | bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints.  We need to | 
|  | process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and | 
|  | unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and | 
|  | "catch unload".  */ | 
|  | for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event) | 
|  | { | 
|  | handle_solib_event (); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and | 
|  | check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher | 
|  | layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | removed_any = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!bs->stop) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
|  | b->ops->check_status (bs); | 
|  | if (bs->stop) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bs->stop) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ++(b->hit_count); | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We will stop here.  */ | 
|  | if (b->disposition == disp_disable) | 
|  | { | 
|  | --(b->enable_count); | 
|  | if (b->enable_count <= 0) | 
|  | b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
|  | removed_any = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (b->silent) | 
|  | bs->print = 0; | 
|  | bs->commands = b->commands; | 
|  | incref_counted_command_line (bs->commands); | 
|  | if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands | 
|  | ? bs->commands->commands : NULL)) | 
|  | bs->print = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | b->ops->after_condition_true (bs); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't | 
|  | print.  */ | 
|  | if (!bs->stop || !bs->print) | 
|  | bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may | 
|  | not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are | 
|  | watching may have.  Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get | 
|  | done later.  */ | 
|  | need_remove_insert = 0; | 
|  | if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head)) | 
|  | for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | 
|  | if (!bs->stop | 
|  | && bs->breakpoint_at | 
|  | && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at; | 
|  |  | 
|  | update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse.  */); | 
|  | need_remove_insert = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (need_remove_insert) | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
|  | else if (removed_any) | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return bs_head; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | handle_jit_event (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct frame_info *frame; | 
|  | struct gdbarch *gdbarch; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (debug_infrun) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "handling bp_jit_event\n"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by | 
|  | breakpoint_re_set.  */ | 
|  | target_terminal_ours_for_output (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | frame = get_current_frame (); | 
|  | gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame); | 
|  |  | 
|  | jit_event_handler (gdbarch); | 
|  |  | 
|  | target_terminal_inferior (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct bpstat_what | 
|  | bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bpstat_what retval; | 
|  | bpstat bs; | 
|  |  | 
|  | retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING; | 
|  | retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE; | 
|  | retval.is_longjmp = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Extract this BS's action.  After processing each BS, we check | 
|  | if its action overrides all we've seem so far.  */ | 
|  | enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING; | 
|  | enum bptype bptype; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary | 
|  | breakpoint which has since been deleted.  */ | 
|  | bptype = bp_none; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (bptype) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case bp_none: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_breakpoint: | 
|  | case bp_hardware_breakpoint: | 
|  | case bp_single_step: | 
|  | case bp_until: | 
|  | case bp_finish: | 
|  | case bp_shlib_event: | 
|  | if (bs->stop) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bs->print) | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY; | 
|  | else | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_watchpoint: | 
|  | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
|  | case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
|  | case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
|  | if (bs->stop) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bs->print) | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY; | 
|  | else | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping. | 
|  | This requires no further action.  */ | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_longjmp: | 
|  | case bp_longjmp_call_dummy: | 
|  | case bp_exception: | 
|  | if (bs->stop) | 
|  | { | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME; | 
|  | retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_longjmp_resume: | 
|  | case bp_exception_resume: | 
|  | if (bs->stop) | 
|  | { | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME; | 
|  | retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_step_resume: | 
|  | if (bs->stop) | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* It is for the wrong frame.  */ | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_hp_step_resume: | 
|  | if (bs->stop) | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* It is for the wrong frame.  */ | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_watchpoint_scope: | 
|  | case bp_thread_event: | 
|  | case bp_overlay_event: | 
|  | case bp_longjmp_master: | 
|  | case bp_std_terminate_master: | 
|  | case bp_exception_master: | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_catchpoint: | 
|  | if (bs->stop) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bs->print) | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY; | 
|  | else | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping. | 
|  | This requires no further action.  */ | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_jit_event: | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_call_dummy: | 
|  | /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy), | 
|  | so infrun.c pops the dummy frame.  */ | 
|  | retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY; | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_std_terminate: | 
|  | /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy), | 
|  | so infrun.c pops the dummy frame.  */ | 
|  | retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE; | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_tracepoint: | 
|  | case bp_fast_tracepoint: | 
|  | case bp_static_tracepoint: | 
|  | /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and | 
|  | if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered | 
|  | out already.  */ | 
|  | internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, | 
|  | _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered")); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver: | 
|  | /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return).  */ | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return: | 
|  | /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the | 
|  | PC of the former breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bp_dprintf: | 
|  | if (bs->stop) | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; | 
|  | else | 
|  | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | default: | 
|  | internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, | 
|  | _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | retval.main_action = std::max (retval.main_action, this_action); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return retval; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat bs_head) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bpstat bs; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (b == NULL) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | switch (b->type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case bp_jit_event: | 
|  | handle_jit_event (); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver: | 
|  | gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return: | 
|  | gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines | 
|  | without hardware support).  This isn't related to a specific bpstat, | 
|  | just to things like whether watchpoints are set.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | bpstat_should_step (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | 
|  | if (bs->stop) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line | 
|  | so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column | 
|  | named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static char * | 
|  | wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | static char wrap_indent[80]; | 
|  | int i, total_width, width, align; | 
|  | const char *text; | 
|  |  | 
|  | total_width = 0; | 
|  | for (i = 1; uiout->query_table_field (i, &width, &align, &text); i++) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent); | 
|  | memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width); | 
|  | wrap_indent[total_width] = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return wrap_indent; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | total_width += width + 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions | 
|  | evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both.  Returns the following: | 
|  |  | 
|  | "host": Host evals condition. | 
|  | "host or target": Host or Target evals condition. | 
|  | "target": Target evals condition. | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static const char * | 
|  | bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl; | 
|  | char host_evals = 0; | 
|  | char target_evals = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!b) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!is_breakpoint (b)) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () | 
|  | || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | 
|  | return condition_evaluation_host; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bl->cond_bytecode) | 
|  | target_evals++; | 
|  | else | 
|  | host_evals++; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (host_evals && target_evals) | 
|  | return condition_evaluation_both; | 
|  | else if (target_evals) | 
|  | return condition_evaluation_target; | 
|  | else | 
|  | return condition_evaluation_host; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator.  This is | 
|  | similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static const char * | 
|  | bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner)) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () | 
|  | || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | 
|  | return condition_evaluation_host; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode) | 
|  | return condition_evaluation_target; | 
|  | else | 
|  | return condition_evaluation_host; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled) | 
|  | loc = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (loc != NULL) | 
|  | set_current_program_space (loc->pspace); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (b->display_canonical) | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("what", event_location_to_string (b->location)); | 
|  | else if (loc && loc->symtab) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct symbol *sym | 
|  | = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section); | 
|  | if (sym) | 
|  | { | 
|  | uiout->text ("in "); | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("func", SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym)); | 
|  | uiout->text (" "); | 
|  | uiout->wrap_hint (wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what")); | 
|  | uiout->text ("at "); | 
|  | } | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("file", | 
|  | symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab)); | 
|  | uiout->text (":"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("fullname", symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("line", loc->line_number); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (loc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct ui_file *stb = mem_fileopen (); | 
|  | struct cleanup *stb_chain = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb); | 
|  |  | 
|  | print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, stb, | 
|  | demangle, ""); | 
|  | uiout->field_stream ("at", stb); | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (stb_chain); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("pending", event_location_to_string (b->location)); | 
|  | /* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition | 
|  | or dprintf arguments.  In either case, make sure it is printed, | 
|  | too, but only for non-MI streams.  */ | 
|  | if (!uiout->is_mi_like_p () && b->extra_string != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_dprintf) | 
|  | uiout->text (","); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->text (" "); | 
|  | uiout->text (b->extra_string); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (loc && is_breakpoint (b) | 
|  | && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target | 
|  | && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both) | 
|  | { | 
|  | uiout->text (" ("); | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by", | 
|  | bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc)); | 
|  | uiout->text (")"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static const char * | 
|  | bptype_string (enum bptype type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct ep_type_description | 
|  | { | 
|  | enum bptype type; | 
|  | char *description; | 
|  | }; | 
|  | static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] = | 
|  | { | 
|  | {bp_none, "?deleted?"}, | 
|  | {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"}, | 
|  | {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"}, | 
|  | {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"}, | 
|  | {bp_until, "until"}, | 
|  | {bp_finish, "finish"}, | 
|  | {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"}, | 
|  | {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"}, | 
|  | {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"}, | 
|  | {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"}, | 
|  | {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"}, | 
|  | {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"}, | 
|  | {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"}, | 
|  | {bp_exception, "exception"}, | 
|  | {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"}, | 
|  | {bp_step_resume, "step resume"}, | 
|  | {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"}, | 
|  | {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"}, | 
|  | {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"}, | 
|  | {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"}, | 
|  | {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"}, | 
|  | {bp_thread_event, "thread events"}, | 
|  | {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"}, | 
|  | {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"}, | 
|  | {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"}, | 
|  | {bp_exception_master, "exception master"}, | 
|  | {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"}, | 
|  | {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"}, | 
|  | {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"}, | 
|  | {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"}, | 
|  | {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"}, | 
|  | {bp_jit_event, "jit events"}, | 
|  | {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"}, | 
|  | {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"}, | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0]))) | 
|  | || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type)) | 
|  | internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, | 
|  | _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."), | 
|  | (int) type); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return bptypes[(int) type].description; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value. | 
|  | For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout, | 
|  | const char *field_name, | 
|  | VEC(int) *inf_num, | 
|  | int mi_only) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cleanup *back_to; | 
|  | int is_mi = uiout->is_mi_like_p (); | 
|  | int inf; | 
|  | int i; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless | 
|  | there are several.  Always display them for MI. */ | 
|  | if (!is_mi && mi_only) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | back_to = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (uiout, field_name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (int, inf_num, i, inf); ++i) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (is_mi) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char mi_group[10]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf); | 
|  | uiout->field_string (NULL, mi_group); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (i == 0) | 
|  | uiout->text (" inf "); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->text (", "); | 
|  |  | 
|  | uiout->text (plongest (inf)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (back_to); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print B to gdb_stdout.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc, | 
|  | int loc_number, | 
|  | struct bp_location **last_loc, | 
|  | int allflag) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct command_line *l; | 
|  | static char bpenables[] = "nynny"; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  | int header_of_multiple = 0; | 
|  | int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL); | 
|  | struct value_print_options opts; | 
|  |  | 
|  | get_user_print_options (&opts); | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0); | 
|  | /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of | 
|  | breakpoints with single disabled location.  */ | 
|  | if (loc == NULL | 
|  | && (b->loc != NULL | 
|  | && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled))) | 
|  | header_of_multiple = 1; | 
|  | if (loc == NULL) | 
|  | loc = b->loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | annotate_record (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* 1 */ | 
|  | annotate_field (0); | 
|  | if (part_of_multiple) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *formatted; | 
|  | formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number); | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("number", formatted); | 
|  | xfree (formatted); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("number", b->number); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* 2 */ | 
|  | annotate_field (1); | 
|  | if (part_of_multiple) | 
|  | uiout->field_skip ("type"); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("type", bptype_string (b->type)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* 3 */ | 
|  | annotate_field (2); | 
|  | if (part_of_multiple) | 
|  | uiout->field_skip ("disp"); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition)); | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* 4 */ | 
|  | annotate_field (3); | 
|  | if (part_of_multiple) | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n"); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->field_fmt ("enabled", "%c", bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]); | 
|  | uiout->spaces (2); | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* 5 and 6 */ | 
|  | if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Although the print_one can possibly print all locations, | 
|  | calling it here is not likely to get any nice result.  So, | 
|  | make sure there's just one location.  */ | 
|  | gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL); | 
|  | b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | switch (b->type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case bp_none: | 
|  | internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, | 
|  | _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n")); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bp_watchpoint: | 
|  | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
|  | case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
|  | case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns | 
|  | not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect | 
|  | is relatively readable).  */ | 
|  | if (opts.addressprint) | 
|  | uiout->field_skip ("addr"); | 
|  | annotate_field (5); | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("what", w->exp_string); | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bp_breakpoint: | 
|  | case bp_hardware_breakpoint: | 
|  | case bp_single_step: | 
|  | case bp_until: | 
|  | case bp_finish: | 
|  | case bp_longjmp: | 
|  | case bp_longjmp_resume: | 
|  | case bp_longjmp_call_dummy: | 
|  | case bp_exception: | 
|  | case bp_exception_resume: | 
|  | case bp_step_resume: | 
|  | case bp_hp_step_resume: | 
|  | case bp_watchpoint_scope: | 
|  | case bp_call_dummy: | 
|  | case bp_std_terminate: | 
|  | case bp_shlib_event: | 
|  | case bp_thread_event: | 
|  | case bp_overlay_event: | 
|  | case bp_longjmp_master: | 
|  | case bp_std_terminate_master: | 
|  | case bp_exception_master: | 
|  | case bp_tracepoint: | 
|  | case bp_fast_tracepoint: | 
|  | case bp_static_tracepoint: | 
|  | case bp_dprintf: | 
|  | case bp_jit_event: | 
|  | case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver: | 
|  | case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return: | 
|  | if (opts.addressprint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | annotate_field (4); | 
|  | if (header_of_multiple) | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("addr", "<MULTIPLE>"); | 
|  | else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled) | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("addr", "<PENDING>"); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->field_core_addr ("addr", | 
|  | loc->gdbarch, loc->address); | 
|  | } | 
|  | annotate_field (5); | 
|  | if (!header_of_multiple) | 
|  | print_breakpoint_location (b, loc); | 
|  | if (b->loc) | 
|  | *last_loc = b->loc; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct inferior *inf; | 
|  | VEC(int) *inf_num = NULL; | 
|  | int mi_only = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_INFERIORS (inf) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace) | 
|  | VEC_safe_push (int, inf_num, inf->num); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless | 
|  | there are several.  Always display for MI. */ | 
|  | if (allflag | 
|  | || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()) | 
|  | && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1 | 
|  | || number_of_inferiors () > 1) | 
|  | /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in | 
|  | moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER.  */ | 
|  | && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint)) | 
|  | mi_only = 0; | 
|  | output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_num, mi_only); | 
|  | VEC_free (int, inf_num); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!part_of_multiple) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b->thread != -1) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the | 
|  | "stop only in" line a little further down.  */ | 
|  | uiout->text (" thread "); | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("thread", b->thread); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (b->task != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | uiout->text (" task "); | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("task", b->task); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | uiout->text ("\n"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!part_of_multiple) | 
|  | b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | annotate_field (6); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\tstop only in stack frame at "); | 
|  | /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside | 
|  | the frame ID.  */ | 
|  | uiout->field_core_addr ("frame", | 
|  | b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string) | 
|  | { | 
|  | annotate_field (7); | 
|  | if (is_tracepoint (b)) | 
|  | uiout->text ("\ttrace only if "); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->text ("\tstop only if "); | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("cond", b->cond_string); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition | 
|  | evaluation.  If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything.  */ | 
|  | if (is_breakpoint (b) | 
|  | && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () | 
|  | == condition_evaluation_target) | 
|  | { | 
|  | uiout->text (" ("); | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by", | 
|  | bp_condition_evaluator (b)); | 
|  | uiout->text (" evals)"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | uiout->text ("\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* FIXME should make an annotation for this.  */ | 
|  | uiout->text ("\tstop only in thread "); | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("thread", b->thread); | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b->thread); | 
|  |  | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("thread", print_thread_id (thr)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | uiout->text ("\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!part_of_multiple) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b->hit_count) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* FIXME should make an annotation for this.  */ | 
|  | if (is_catchpoint (b)) | 
|  | uiout->text ("\tcatchpoint"); | 
|  | else if (is_tracepoint (b)) | 
|  | uiout->text ("\ttracepoint"); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->text ("\tbreakpoint"); | 
|  | uiout->text (" already hit "); | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("times", b->hit_count); | 
|  | if (b->hit_count == 1) | 
|  | uiout->text (" time\n"); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->text (" times\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi.  */ | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("times", b->hit_count); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count) | 
|  | { | 
|  | annotate_field (8); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\tignore next "); | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("ignore", b->ignore_count); | 
|  | uiout->text (" hits\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once" | 
|  | behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and | 
|  | disposition, so we don't need to mention it here.  */ | 
|  | if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1) | 
|  | { | 
|  | annotate_field (8); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\tdisable after "); | 
|  | /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts | 
|  | are distinct, and have additive effect.  */ | 
|  | if (b->ignore_count) | 
|  | uiout->text ("additional "); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->text ("next "); | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("enable", b->enable_count); | 
|  | uiout->text (" hits\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (tp->traceframe_usage) | 
|  | { | 
|  | uiout->text ("\ttrace buffer usage "); | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage); | 
|  | uiout->text (" bytes\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | l = b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL; | 
|  | if (!part_of_multiple && l) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cleanup *script_chain; | 
|  |  | 
|  | annotate_field (9); | 
|  | script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script"); | 
|  | print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4); | 
|  | do_cleanups (script_chain); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (is_tracepoint (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count) | 
|  | { | 
|  | annotate_field (10); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\tpass count "); | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("pass", t->pass_count); | 
|  | uiout->text (" \n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is | 
|  | pending.   */ | 
|  | if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled) | 
|  | { | 
|  | annotate_field (11); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("installed", | 
|  | loc->inserted ? "y" : "n"); | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (loc->inserted) | 
|  | uiout->text ("\t"); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->text ("\tnot "); | 
|  | uiout->text ("installed on target\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && !part_of_multiple) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (is_watchpoint (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("original-location", w->exp_string); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (b->location != NULL | 
|  | && event_location_to_string (b->location) != NULL) | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("original-location", | 
|  | event_location_to_string (b->location)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | struct bp_location **last_loc, | 
|  | int allflag) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cleanup *bkpt_chain; | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag); | 
|  | do_cleanups (bkpt_chain); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If this breakpoint has custom print function, | 
|  | it's already printed.  Otherwise, print individual | 
|  | locations, if any.  */ | 
|  | if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we | 
|  | print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's | 
|  | hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled" | 
|  | situation. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations | 
|  | internally, that's not a property exposed to user.  */ | 
|  | if (b->loc | 
|  | && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b) | 
|  | && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  | int n = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cleanup *inner2 = | 
|  | make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, NULL); | 
|  | print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc, allflag); | 
|  | do_cleanups (inner2); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int print_address_bits = 0; | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have an | 
|  | address to print.  */ | 
|  | if (is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (b)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int addr_bit; | 
|  |  | 
|  | addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch); | 
|  | if (addr_bit > print_address_bits) | 
|  | print_address_bits = addr_bit; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return print_address_bits; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct captured_breakpoint_query_args | 
|  | { | 
|  | int bnum; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args | 
|  | = (struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *) data; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (args->bnum == b->number) | 
|  | { | 
|  | print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0); | 
|  | return GDB_RC_OK; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | return GDB_RC_NONE; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | enum gdb_rc | 
|  | gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum, | 
|  | char **error_message) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args; | 
|  |  | 
|  | args.bnum = bnum; | 
|  | /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw | 
|  | an error.  */ | 
|  | if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args, | 
|  | error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0) | 
|  | return GDB_RC_FAIL; | 
|  | else | 
|  | return GDB_RC_OK; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is | 
|  | internal or momentary.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return b->number > 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | pending_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return b->loc == NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc) | 
|  | number BNUM.  If BNUM is -1 print all user-settable breakpoints. | 
|  | If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non-user-settable breakpoints.  If | 
|  | FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the | 
|  | ones for which it returns non-zero.  Return the total number of | 
|  | breakpoints listed.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_1 (char *args, int allflag, | 
|  | int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL; | 
|  | int nr_printable_breakpoints; | 
|  | struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain; | 
|  | struct value_print_options opts; | 
|  | int print_address_bits = 0; | 
|  | int print_type_col_width = 14; | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  |  | 
|  | get_user_print_options (&opts); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size | 
|  | required for address fields.  */ | 
|  | nr_printable_breakpoints = 0; | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts.  */ | 
|  | if (filter && !filter (b)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to | 
|  | accept.  Skip the others.  */ | 
|  | if (args != NULL && *args != '\0') | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (allflag && parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | if (!allflag && !number_is_in_list (args, b->number)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int addr_bit, type_len; | 
|  |  | 
|  | addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b); | 
|  | if (addr_bit > print_address_bits) | 
|  | print_address_bits = addr_bit; | 
|  |  | 
|  | type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type)); | 
|  | if (type_len > print_type_col_width) | 
|  | print_type_col_width = type_len; | 
|  |  | 
|  | nr_printable_breakpoints++; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (opts.addressprint) | 
|  | bkpttbl_chain | 
|  | = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6, | 
|  | nr_printable_breakpoints, | 
|  | "BreakpointTable"); | 
|  | else | 
|  | bkpttbl_chain | 
|  | = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5, | 
|  | nr_printable_breakpoints, | 
|  | "BreakpointTable"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | 
|  | annotate_breakpoints_headers (); | 
|  | if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | 
|  | annotate_field (0); | 
|  | uiout->table_header (7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */ | 
|  | if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | 
|  | annotate_field (1); | 
|  | uiout->table_header (print_type_col_width, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */ | 
|  | if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | 
|  | annotate_field (2); | 
|  | uiout->table_header (4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */ | 
|  | if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | 
|  | annotate_field (3); | 
|  | uiout->table_header (3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */ | 
|  | if (opts.addressprint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | 
|  | annotate_field (4); | 
|  | if (print_address_bits <= 32) | 
|  | uiout->table_header (10, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */ | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->table_header (18, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */ | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | 
|  | annotate_field (5); | 
|  | uiout->table_header (40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */ | 
|  | uiout->table_body (); | 
|  | if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | 
|  | annotate_breakpoints_table (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | QUIT; | 
|  | /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts.  */ | 
|  | if (filter && !filter (b)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to | 
|  | accept.  Skip the others.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (args != NULL && *args != '\0') | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (allflag)	/* maintenance info breakpoint */ | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else		/* all others */ | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!number_is_in_list (args, b->number)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the | 
|  | allflag is set.  */ | 
|  | if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b)) | 
|  | print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, allflag); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report | 
|  | empty list.  */ | 
|  | if (!filter) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (args == NULL || *args == '\0') | 
|  | uiout->message ("No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n"); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->message ("No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", | 
|  | args); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (last_loc && !server_command) | 
|  | set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* FIXME?  Should this be moved up so that it is only called when | 
|  | there have been breakpoints? */ | 
|  | annotate_breakpoints_table_end (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return nr_printable_breakpoints; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally | 
|  | compatible with the breakpoint list.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | default_collect_info (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a | 
|  | message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's | 
|  | not wanted.  */ | 
|  | if (!*default_collect) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect | 
|  | actions.  */ | 
|  | uiout->text ("default collect "); | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("default-collect", default_collect); | 
|  | uiout->text (" \n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | breakpoints_info (char *args, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | breakpoint_1 (args, 0, NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | default_collect_info (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | watchpoints_info (char *args, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_watchpoint); | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (num_printed == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (args == NULL || *args == '\0') | 
|  | uiout->message ("No watchpoints.\n"); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->message ("No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *args, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | breakpoint_1 (args, 1, NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | default_collect_info (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | struct program_space *pspace, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl = b->loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (; bl; bl = bl->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bl->pspace == pspace | 
|  | && bl->address == pc | 
|  | && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section)) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC.  This | 
|  | concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not | 
|  | address spaces.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc, | 
|  | struct obj_section *section, int thread) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int others = 0; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | others += (user_breakpoint_p (b) | 
|  | && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section)); | 
|  | if (others > 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (others == 1) | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint ")); | 
|  | else /* if (others == ???) */ | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints ")); | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | others--; | 
|  | printf_filtered ("%d", b->number); | 
|  | if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1) | 
|  | printf_filtered (" (all threads)"); | 
|  | else if (b->thread != -1) | 
|  | printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread); | 
|  | printf_filtered ("%s%s ", | 
|  | ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled | 
|  | || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled) | 
|  | ? " (disabled)" | 
|  | : ""), | 
|  | (others > 1) ? "," | 
|  | : ((others == 1) ? " and" : "")); | 
|  | } | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("also set at pc ")); | 
|  | fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout); | 
|  | printf_filtered (".\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of | 
|  | BPT locations.  For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members | 
|  | are irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to other | 
|  | addresses (or use them for any other purpose either). | 
|  |  | 
|  | More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will | 
|  | always have a zero valued location address and we don't want to mark | 
|  | breakpoints of any of these types to be a duplicate of an actual | 
|  | breakpoint location at address zero: | 
|  |  | 
|  | bp_watchpoint | 
|  | bp_catchpoint | 
|  |  | 
|  | */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | enum bptype type = bpt->type; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns | 
|  | true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc2) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner; | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Both of them must exist.  */ | 
|  | gdb_assert (w1 != NULL); | 
|  | gdb_assert (w2 != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware, | 
|  | then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at | 
|  | the same place.  Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when | 
|  | the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to | 
|  | true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the | 
|  | other watchpoint.  */ | 
|  | if ((w1->cond_exp | 
|  | && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address, | 
|  | loc1->length, | 
|  | loc1->watchpoint_type, | 
|  | w1->cond_exp.get ())) | 
|  | || (w2->cond_exp | 
|  | && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address, | 
|  | loc2->length, | 
|  | loc2->watchpoint_type, | 
|  | w2->cond_exp.get ()))) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's.  In | 
|  | case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does | 
|  | support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint | 
|  | watchpoints with hw_access locations.  Those should be considered | 
|  | duplicates of hw_read locations.  The hw_read locations will | 
|  | become hw_access locations later.  */ | 
|  | return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type | 
|  | && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace | 
|  | && loc1->address == loc2->address | 
|  | && loc1->length == loc2->length); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1, | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()) | 
|  | || aspace1 == aspace2) | 
|  | && addr1 == addr2); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by | 
|  | {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}.  In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1 | 
|  | matches ASPACE2.  On targets that have global breakpoints, the address | 
|  | space doesn't really matter.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_address_match_range (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1, | 
|  | int len1, struct address_space *aspace2, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR addr2) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()) | 
|  | || aspace1 == aspace2) | 
|  | && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL.  BL may be | 
|  | a ranged breakpoint.  In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE | 
|  | matches the breakpoint's address space.  On targets that have global | 
|  | breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl, | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR addr) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address, | 
|  | aspace, addr) | 
|  | || (bl->length | 
|  | && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, | 
|  | bl->address, bl->length, | 
|  | aspace, addr))); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps | 
|  | breakpoint BL.  BL may be a ranged breakpoint.  In most targets, a | 
|  | match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address | 
|  | space.  On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space | 
|  | doesn't really matter.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *bl, | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR addr, int len) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()) | 
|  | || bl->pspace->aspace == aspace) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int bl_len = bl->length != 0 ? bl->length : 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr, len, bl->address, bl_len)) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly. | 
|  | Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns | 
|  | true, otherwise returns false.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc2) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner)) | 
|  | /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint | 
|  | locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as | 
|  | different locations.  */ | 
|  | return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner); | 
|  | else | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses | 
|  | (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2 | 
|  | represent the same location.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc2) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int hw_point1, hw_point2; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations.  */ | 
|  | gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL); | 
|  | gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner); | 
|  | hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (hw_point1 != hw_point2) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | else if (hw_point1) | 
|  | return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2); | 
|  | else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner)) | 
|  | return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2); | 
|  | else | 
|  | /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address, | 
|  | loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address) | 
|  | && loc1->length == loc2->length); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr, | 
|  | int bnum, int have_bnum) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom | 
|  | is 50 chars.  These must be at least that big for safety.  */ | 
|  | char astr1[64]; | 
|  | char astr2[64]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8)); | 
|  | strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8)); | 
|  | if (have_bnum) | 
|  | warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."), | 
|  | bnum, astr1, astr2); | 
|  | else | 
|  | warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural | 
|  | constraints on breakpoint placement.  Return the adjusted address. | 
|  | Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment.  For most | 
|  | targets, this function is simply the identity function.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static CORE_ADDR | 
|  | adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment.  */ | 
|  | return bpaddr; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint | 
|  | || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint | 
|  | || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint | 
|  | || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint | 
|  | || bptype == bp_catchpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not | 
|  | have their addresses modified.  */ | 
|  | return bpaddr; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (bptype == bp_single_step) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses | 
|  | modified.  If there's any architectural constrain that | 
|  | applies to this address, then it should have already been | 
|  | taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the | 
|  | first place.  If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g., | 
|  | Thumb-2 IT blocks would break.  */ | 
|  | return bpaddr; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement | 
|  | of breakpoint instructions.  Obtain the adjusted address.  */ | 
|  | adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter | 
|  | a user's expectations.  Print a warning if an adjustment | 
|  | is required.  */ | 
|  | if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr) | 
|  | breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return adjusted_bpaddr; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | init_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc, const struct bp_location_ops *ops, | 
|  | struct breakpoint *owner) | 
|  | { | 
|  | memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (ops != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | loc->ops = ops; | 
|  | loc->owner = owner; | 
|  | loc->cond_bytecode = NULL; | 
|  | loc->shlib_disabled = 0; | 
|  | loc->enabled = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (owner->type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case bp_breakpoint: | 
|  | case bp_single_step: | 
|  | case bp_until: | 
|  | case bp_finish: | 
|  | case bp_longjmp: | 
|  | case bp_longjmp_resume: | 
|  | case bp_longjmp_call_dummy: | 
|  | case bp_exception: | 
|  | case bp_exception_resume: | 
|  | case bp_step_resume: | 
|  | case bp_hp_step_resume: | 
|  | case bp_watchpoint_scope: | 
|  | case bp_call_dummy: | 
|  | case bp_std_terminate: | 
|  | case bp_shlib_event: | 
|  | case bp_thread_event: | 
|  | case bp_overlay_event: | 
|  | case bp_jit_event: | 
|  | case bp_longjmp_master: | 
|  | case bp_std_terminate_master: | 
|  | case bp_exception_master: | 
|  | case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver: | 
|  | case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return: | 
|  | case bp_dprintf: | 
|  | loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint; | 
|  | mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_hardware_breakpoint: | 
|  | loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint; | 
|  | mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
|  | case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
|  | case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
|  | loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_watchpoint: | 
|  | case bp_catchpoint: | 
|  | case bp_tracepoint: | 
|  | case bp_fast_tracepoint: | 
|  | case bp_static_tracepoint: | 
|  | loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | loc->refc = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Allocate a struct bp_location.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct bp_location * | 
|  | allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | loc->ops->dtor (loc); | 
|  | delete loc; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Increment reference count.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ++bl->refc; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Decrement reference count.  If the reference count reaches 0, | 
|  | destroy the bp_location.  Sets *BLP to NULL.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (--(*blp)->refc == 0) | 
|  | free_bp_location (*blp); | 
|  | *blp = NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | add_to_breakpoint_chain (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of | 
|  | breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | b1 = breakpoint_chain; | 
|  | if (b1 == 0) | 
|  | breakpoint_chain = b; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | while (b1->next) | 
|  | b1 = b1->next; | 
|  | b1->next = b; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | enum bptype bptype, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops) | 
|  | { | 
|  | memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (ops != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | b->ops = ops; | 
|  | b->type = bptype; | 
|  | b->gdbarch = gdbarch; | 
|  | b->language = current_language->la_language; | 
|  | b->input_radix = input_radix; | 
|  | b->thread = -1; | 
|  | b->enable_state = bp_enabled; | 
|  | b->next = 0; | 
|  | b->silent = 0; | 
|  | b->ignore_count = 0; | 
|  | b->commands = NULL; | 
|  | b->frame_id = null_frame_id; | 
|  | b->condition_not_parsed = 0; | 
|  | b->py_bp_object = NULL; | 
|  | b->related_breakpoint = b; | 
|  | b->location = NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below.  Creates a breakpoint | 
|  | that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct breakpoint * | 
|  | set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | enum bptype bptype, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = new breakpoint (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops); | 
|  | add_to_breakpoint_chain (b); | 
|  | return b; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Initialize loc->function_name.  EXPLICIT_LOC says no indirect function | 
|  | resolutions should be made as the user specified the location explicitly | 
|  | enough.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc, int explicit_loc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint | 
|  | || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint | 
|  | || is_tracepoint (loc->owner)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int is_gnu_ifunc; | 
|  | const char *function_name; | 
|  | CORE_ADDR func_addr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | find_pc_partial_function_gnu_ifunc (loc->address, &function_name, | 
|  | &func_addr, NULL, &is_gnu_ifunc); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (is_gnu_ifunc && !explicit_loc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner; | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (loc->pspace == current_program_space); | 
|  | if (gnu_ifunc_resolve_name (function_name, | 
|  | &loc->requested_address)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Recalculate ADDRESS based on new REQUESTED_ADDRESS.  */ | 
|  | loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch, | 
|  | loc->requested_address, | 
|  | b->type); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc | 
|  | && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not | 
|  | mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations.  */ | 
|  | b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver; | 
|  | /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return | 
|  | breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | loc->related_address = func_addr; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (function_name) | 
|  | loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL.  */ | 
|  | struct gdbarch * | 
|  | get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (sal.section) | 
|  | return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile); | 
|  | if (sal.symtab) | 
|  | return get_objfile_arch (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type | 
|  | BPTYPE.  The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source | 
|  | file name, and line number are provided by SAL. | 
|  |  | 
|  | It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of | 
|  | the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status | 
|  | information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops) | 
|  | { | 
|  | init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bptype != bp_catchpoint) | 
|  | gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint, | 
|  | except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the | 
|  | program space.  */ | 
|  | if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | b->pspace = sal.pspace; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and | 
|  | partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE.  The newly | 
|  | created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line | 
|  | number are provided by SAL.  The newly created and partially | 
|  | initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and | 
|  | is also returned as the value of this function. | 
|  |  | 
|  | It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of | 
|  | the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status | 
|  | information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint.  In | 
|  | particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint | 
|  | number!  Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur | 
|  | prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint.  If this | 
|  | should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct breakpoint * | 
|  | set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = new breakpoint (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops); | 
|  | add_to_breakpoint_chain (b); | 
|  | return b; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint | 
|  | if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP.  FRAME is the frame which | 
|  | initiated the operation.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp; | 
|  | int thread = tp->global_num; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step, | 
|  | we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled | 
|  | longjmp "master" breakpoints.  Here, we simply create momentary | 
|  | clones of those and enable them for the requested thread.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp) | 
|  | if (b->pspace == current_program_space | 
|  | && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master | 
|  | || b->type == bp_exception_master)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *clone; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again | 
|  | after their removal.  */ | 
|  | clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type, | 
|  | &longjmp_breakpoint_ops, 1); | 
|  | clone->thread = thread; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | tp->initiating_frame = frame; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD.  */ | 
|  | void | 
|  | delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp) | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b->thread == thread) | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp) | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b->thread == thread) | 
|  | b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for | 
|  | INFERIOR_PTID thread.  Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return | 
|  | pointer to any of them.  Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp | 
|  | breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct breakpoint * | 
|  | set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *retval = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *new_b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy, | 
|  | &momentary_breakpoint_ops, | 
|  | 1); | 
|  | new_b->thread = ptid_to_global_thread_id (inferior_ptid); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b); | 
|  | if (retval == NULL) | 
|  | retval = new_b; | 
|  | new_b->related_breakpoint = retval; | 
|  | while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint) | 
|  | retval = retval->related_breakpoint; | 
|  | retval->related_breakpoint = new_b; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return retval; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for | 
|  | TP.  Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame | 
|  | stack. | 
|  |  | 
|  | You should call this function only at places where it is safe to currently | 
|  | unwind the whole stack.  Failed stack unwind would discard live dummy | 
|  | frames.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp) | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->global_num) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint; | 
|  |  | 
|  | while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy) | 
|  | dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint; | 
|  | if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy | 
|  | || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp->ptid); | 
|  |  | 
|  | while (b->related_breakpoint != b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint) | 
|  | b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next; | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint); | 
|  | } | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | enable_overlay_breakpoints (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_overlay_event) | 
|  | { | 
|  | b->enable_state = bp_enabled; | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
|  | overlay_events_enabled = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | disable_overlay_breakpoints (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_overlay_event) | 
|  | { | 
|  | b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
|  | overlay_events_enabled = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate | 
|  | master breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | void | 
|  | set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp) | 
|  | if (b->pspace == current_program_space | 
|  | && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master) | 
|  | { | 
|  | momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate, | 
|  | &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | void | 
|  | delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp) | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_std_terminate) | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct breakpoint * | 
|  | create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event, | 
|  | &internal_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  |  | 
|  | b->enable_state = bp_enabled; | 
|  | /* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me.  */ | 
|  | b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return b; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct lang_and_radix | 
|  | { | 
|  | enum language lang; | 
|  | int radix; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct breakpoint * | 
|  | create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event, | 
|  | &internal_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s).  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp) | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_jit_event | 
|  | && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space) | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp) | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_shlib_event | 
|  | && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space) | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp) | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_shlib_event | 
|  | && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space) | 
|  | b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint / | 
|  | create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint.  Allows specifying which | 
|  | INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct breakpoint * | 
|  | create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address, | 
|  | enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event, | 
|  | &internal_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  | update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode); | 
|  | return b; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct breakpoint * | 
|  | create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct breakpoint * | 
|  | create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert | 
|  | locations.  */ | 
|  | b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT); | 
|  | if (!b->loc->inserted) | 
|  | { | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return b; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries.  Only | 
|  | apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL.  */ | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for | 
|  | those with loc->duplicate set.  This is so that when breakpoint | 
|  | becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to | 
|  | insert all breakpoints.  If we don't set shlib_disabled here, | 
|  | we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail.  */ | 
|  | if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint) | 
|  | || (b->type == bp_jit_event) | 
|  | || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | || (is_tracepoint (b))) | 
|  | && loc->pspace == current_program_space | 
|  | && !loc->shlib_disabled | 
|  | && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address) | 
|  | ) | 
|  | { | 
|  | loc->shlib_disabled = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon | 
|  | notification of unloaded_shlib.  Only apply to enabled breakpoints, | 
|  | disabled ones can just stay disabled.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp; | 
|  | int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL.  */ | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace | 
|  | && !loc->shlib_disabled | 
|  | && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint | 
|  | || b->type == bp_jit_event | 
|  | || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint | 
|  | || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint)) | 
|  | || is_tracepoint (b)) | 
|  | && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | loc->shlib_disabled = 1; | 
|  | /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint | 
|  | succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted | 
|  | to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | loc->inserted = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!disabled_shlib_breaks) | 
|  | { | 
|  | target_terminal_ours_for_output (); | 
|  | warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints " | 
|  | "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""), | 
|  | solib->so_name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | disabled_shlib_breaks = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon | 
|  | notification of free_objfile.  Only apply to enabled breakpoints, | 
|  | disabled ones can just stay disabled.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (objfile == NULL) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually | 
|  | managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file. | 
|  | Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in | 
|  | response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules | 
|  | shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global | 
|  | location list update.  Shared libraries not loaded by the user | 
|  | aren't handled here -- they're already handled in | 
|  | disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's | 
|  | solib_unloaded observer.  We skip objfiles that are not | 
|  | OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the | 
|  | main objfile).  */ | 
|  | if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0 | 
|  | || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  | int bp_modified = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint | 
|  | && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint | 
|  | && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | loc->shlib_disabled = 1; | 
|  | /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was | 
|  | unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the | 
|  | inserted flag alone.  We'll handle failure to | 
|  | uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed | 
|  | unmapped.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bp_modified = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bp_modified) | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork | 
|  | catchpoint.  It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base | 
|  | class; users downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed.  A | 
|  | breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to | 
|  | CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct fork_catchpoint | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The base class.  */ | 
|  | struct breakpoint base; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this | 
|  | catchpoint.  This field is only valid immediately after this | 
|  | catchpoint has triggered.  */ | 
|  | ptid_t forked_inferior_pid; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork | 
|  | catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork | 
|  | catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork | 
|  | catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
|  | const struct target_waitstatus *ws) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid; | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork | 
|  | catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum print_stop_action | 
|  | print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
|  | struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at; | 
|  |  | 
|  | annotate_catchpoint (b->number); | 
|  | maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); | 
|  | if (b->disposition == disp_del) | 
|  | uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint "); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->text ("Catchpoint "); | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | { | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK)); | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number); | 
|  | uiout->text (" (forked process "); | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid)); | 
|  | uiout->text ("), "); | 
|  | return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork | 
|  | catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b; | 
|  | struct value_print_options opts; | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  |  | 
|  | get_user_print_options (&opts); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not | 
|  | line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively | 
|  | readable).  */ | 
|  | if (opts.addressprint) | 
|  | uiout->field_skip ("addr"); | 
|  | annotate_field (5); | 
|  | uiout->text ("fork"); | 
|  | if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | uiout->text (", process "); | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("what", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid)); | 
|  | uiout->spaces (1); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "fork"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork | 
|  | catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork | 
|  | catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork"); | 
|  | print_recreate_thread (b, fp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork | 
|  | catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork | 
|  | catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork | 
|  | catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
|  | const struct target_waitstatus *ws) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid; | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork | 
|  | catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum print_stop_action | 
|  | print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
|  | struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | annotate_catchpoint (b->number); | 
|  | maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); | 
|  | if (b->disposition == disp_del) | 
|  | uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint "); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->text ("Catchpoint "); | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | { | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK)); | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number); | 
|  | uiout->text (" (vforked process "); | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid)); | 
|  | uiout->text ("), "); | 
|  | return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork | 
|  | catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b; | 
|  | struct value_print_options opts; | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  |  | 
|  | get_user_print_options (&opts); | 
|  | /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not | 
|  | line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively | 
|  | readable).  */ | 
|  | if (opts.addressprint) | 
|  | uiout->field_skip ("addr"); | 
|  | annotate_field (5); | 
|  | uiout->text ("vfork"); | 
|  | if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | uiout->text (", process "); | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("what", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid)); | 
|  | uiout->spaces (1); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "vfork"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork | 
|  | catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork | 
|  | catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork"); | 
|  | print_recreate_thread (b, fp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint. | 
|  | It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users | 
|  | downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed.  A breakpoint is | 
|  | really of this type iff its ops pointer points to | 
|  | CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct solib_catchpoint | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The base class.  */ | 
|  | struct breakpoint base; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload".  */ | 
|  | unsigned char is_load; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Regular expression to match, if any.  COMPILED is only valid when | 
|  | REGEX is non-NULL.  */ | 
|  | char *regex; | 
|  | regex_t compiled; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | dtor_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (self->regex) | 
|  | regfree (&self->compiled); | 
|  | xfree (self->regex); | 
|  |  | 
|  | base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore, enum remove_bp_reason reason) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
|  | const struct target_waitstatus *ws) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *other; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *other_bl; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (other == bl->owner) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (other->type != bp_shlib_event) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (self->base.pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->base.pspace) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (other_bl = other->loc; other_bl != NULL; other_bl = other_bl->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws)) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct solib_catchpoint *self | 
|  | = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at; | 
|  | int ix; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (self->is_load) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct so_list *iter; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (ix = 0; | 
|  | VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs, | 
|  | ix, iter); | 
|  | ++ix) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!self->regex | 
|  | || regexec (&self->compiled, iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *iter; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (ix = 0; | 
|  | VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs, | 
|  | ix, iter); | 
|  | ++ix) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!self->regex | 
|  | || regexec (&self->compiled, iter, 0, NULL, 0) == 0) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bs->stop = 0; | 
|  | bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum print_stop_action | 
|  | print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  |  | 
|  | annotate_catchpoint (b->number); | 
|  | maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); | 
|  | if (b->disposition == disp_del) | 
|  | uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint "); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->text ("Catchpoint "); | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\n"); | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition)); | 
|  | print_solib_event (1); | 
|  | return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b; | 
|  | struct value_print_options opts; | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  | char *msg; | 
|  |  | 
|  | get_user_print_options (&opts); | 
|  | /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not | 
|  | line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively | 
|  | readable).  */ | 
|  | if (opts.addressprint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | annotate_field (4); | 
|  | uiout->field_skip ("addr"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | annotate_field (5); | 
|  | if (self->is_load) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (self->regex) | 
|  | msg = xstrprintf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex); | 
|  | else | 
|  | msg = xstrdup (_("load of library")); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (self->regex) | 
|  | msg = xstrprintf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex); | 
|  | else | 
|  | msg = xstrdup (_("unload of library")); | 
|  | } | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("what", msg); | 
|  | xfree (msg); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("catch-type", self->is_load ? "load" : "unload"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number, | 
|  | self->is_load ? "load" : "unload"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s", | 
|  | b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch", | 
|  | self->is_load ? "load" : "unload"); | 
|  | if (self->regex) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex); | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Shared helper function (MI and CLI) for creating and installing | 
|  | a shared object event catchpoint.  If IS_LOAD is non-zero then | 
|  | the events to be caught are load events, otherwise they are | 
|  | unload events.  If IS_TEMP is non-zero the catchpoint is a | 
|  | temporary one.  If ENABLED is non-zero the catchpoint is | 
|  | created in an enabled state.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | add_solib_catchpoint (char *arg, int is_load, int is_temp, int enabled) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct solib_catchpoint *c; | 
|  | struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch (); | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanup; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!arg) | 
|  | arg = ""; | 
|  | arg = skip_spaces (arg); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = new solib_catchpoint (); | 
|  | cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, c); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (*arg != '\0') | 
|  | { | 
|  | int errcode; | 
|  |  | 
|  | errcode = regcomp (&c->compiled, arg, REG_NOSUB); | 
|  | if (errcode != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *err = get_regcomp_error (errcode, &c->compiled); | 
|  |  | 
|  | make_cleanup (xfree, err); | 
|  | error (_("Invalid regexp (%s): %s"), err, arg); | 
|  | } | 
|  | c->regex = xstrdup (arg); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | c->is_load = is_load; | 
|  | init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, is_temp, NULL, | 
|  | &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c->base.enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled; | 
|  |  | 
|  | discard_cleanups (cleanup); | 
|  | install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and | 
|  | "catch unload".  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | catch_load_or_unload (char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load, | 
|  | struct cmd_list_element *command) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int tempflag; | 
|  | const int enabled = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY; | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, tempflag, enabled); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | catch_load_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, | 
|  | struct cmd_list_element *command) | 
|  | { | 
|  | catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | catch_unload_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, | 
|  | struct cmd_list_element *command) | 
|  | { | 
|  | catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Initialize a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind.  If TEMPFLAG | 
|  | is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.  If COND_STRING is | 
|  | not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.  OPS, if not NULL, is | 
|  | the breakpoint_ops structure associated to the catchpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag, | 
|  | char *cond_string, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct symtab_and_line sal; | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_sal (&sal); | 
|  | sal.pspace = current_program_space; | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops); | 
|  |  | 
|  | b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string); | 
|  | b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | install_breakpoint (int internal, struct breakpoint *b, int update_gll) | 
|  | { | 
|  | add_to_breakpoint_chain (b); | 
|  | set_breakpoint_number (internal, b); | 
|  | if (is_tracepoint (b)) | 
|  | set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count); | 
|  | if (!internal) | 
|  | mention (b); | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (update_gll) | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | int tempflag, char *cond_string, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct fork_catchpoint *c = new fork_catchpoint (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid; | 
|  |  | 
|  | install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Exec catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint. | 
|  | It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users | 
|  | downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed.  A breakpoint is | 
|  | really of this type iff its ops pointer points to | 
|  | CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct exec_catchpoint | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The base class.  */ | 
|  | struct breakpoint base; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint. | 
|  | This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has | 
|  | triggered.  */ | 
|  | char *exec_pathname; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for exec | 
|  | catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | dtor_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | xfree (c->exec_pathname); | 
|  |  | 
|  | base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
|  | const struct target_waitstatus *ws) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname); | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum print_stop_action | 
|  | print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
|  | struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | annotate_catchpoint (b->number); | 
|  | maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); | 
|  | if (b->disposition == disp_del) | 
|  | uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint "); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->text ("Catchpoint "); | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | { | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC)); | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number); | 
|  | uiout->text (" (exec'd "); | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("new-exec", c->exec_pathname); | 
|  | uiout->text ("), "); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b; | 
|  | struct value_print_options opts; | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  |  | 
|  | get_user_print_options (&opts); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns | 
|  | not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect | 
|  | is relatively readable).  */ | 
|  | if (opts.addressprint) | 
|  | uiout->field_skip ("addr"); | 
|  | annotate_field (5); | 
|  | uiout->text ("exec"); | 
|  | if (c->exec_pathname != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | uiout->text (", program \""); | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("what", c->exec_pathname); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\" "); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "exec"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec | 
|  | catchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec"); | 
|  | print_recreate_thread (b, fp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | hw_breakpoint_used_count (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i = 0; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b)) | 
|  | for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than | 
|  | one register.  */ | 
|  | i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return i; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware | 
|  | watchpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i = 0; | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!breakpoint_enabled (b)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than | 
|  | one register.  */ | 
|  | i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return i; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of | 
|  | type TYPE in the breakpoints list.  Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED | 
|  | the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other | 
|  | types _not_ TYPE.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except, | 
|  | enum bptype type, int *other_type_used) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i = 0; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | *other_type_used = 0; | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b == except) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | if (!breakpoint_enabled (b)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (b->type == type) | 
|  | i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b); | 
|  | else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)) | 
|  | *other_type_used = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return i; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled; | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled) | 
|  | { | 
|  | b->enable_state = bp_enabled; | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | current_program_space->executing_startup = 1; | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | current_program_space->executing_startup = 0; | 
|  | breakpoint_re_set (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no | 
|  | locations.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct breakpoint * | 
|  | new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread, struct gdbarch *gdbarch) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = new breakpoint (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bp_single_step, | 
|  | &momentary_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  |  | 
|  | b->disposition = disp_donttouch; | 
|  | b->frame_id = null_frame_id; | 
|  |  | 
|  | b->thread = thread; | 
|  | gdb_assert (b->thread != 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_to_breakpoint_chain (b); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return b; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by | 
|  | SAL.  If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that | 
|  | frame.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct breakpoint * | 
|  | set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal, | 
|  | struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or | 
|  | tail-called one.  */ | 
|  | gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  | b->enable_state = bp_enabled; | 
|  | b->disposition = disp_donttouch; | 
|  | b->frame_id = frame_id; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we want | 
|  | momentary breakpoints to be active in only a single thread of | 
|  | control.  */ | 
|  | if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid)) | 
|  | b->thread = ptid_to_global_thread_id (inferior_ptid); | 
|  |  | 
|  | update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return b; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG. | 
|  | The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its | 
|  | breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct breakpoint * | 
|  | momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig, | 
|  | enum bptype type, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, | 
|  | int loc_enabled) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *copy; | 
|  |  | 
|  | copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops); | 
|  | copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy); | 
|  | set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc, 1); | 
|  |  | 
|  | copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch; | 
|  | copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address; | 
|  | copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address; | 
|  | copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section; | 
|  | copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace; | 
|  | copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe; | 
|  | copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number; | 
|  | copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab; | 
|  | copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled; | 
|  | copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id; | 
|  | copy->thread = orig->thread; | 
|  | copy->pspace = orig->pspace; | 
|  |  | 
|  | copy->enable_state = bp_enabled; | 
|  | copy->disposition = disp_donttouch; | 
|  | copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--; | 
|  |  | 
|  | update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
|  | return copy; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG.  Returns NULL if | 
|  | ORIG is NULL.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct breakpoint * | 
|  | clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing.  */ | 
|  | if (orig == NULL) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct breakpoint * | 
|  | set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc, | 
|  | enum bptype type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct symtab_and_line sal; | 
|  |  | 
|  | sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0); | 
|  | sal.pc = pc; | 
|  | sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc); | 
|  | sal.explicit_pc = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | mention (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | b->ops->print_mention (b); | 
|  | if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | printf_filtered ("\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct bp_location * | 
|  | add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | const struct symtab_and_line *sal) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc, **tmp; | 
|  | CORE_ADDR adjusted_address; | 
|  | struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (loc_gdbarch == NULL) | 
|  | loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location. | 
|  | Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized | 
|  | location will be placed on the location chain.  Adjustment of the | 
|  | breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do | 
|  | not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and | 
|  | location that's only been partially initialized.  */ | 
|  | adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch, | 
|  | sal->pc, b->type); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS.  */ | 
|  | loc = allocate_bp_location (b); | 
|  | for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address; | 
|  | tmp = &((*tmp)->next)) | 
|  | ; | 
|  | loc->next = *tmp; | 
|  | *tmp = loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | loc->requested_address = sal->pc; | 
|  | loc->address = adjusted_address; | 
|  | loc->pspace = sal->pspace; | 
|  | loc->probe.probe = sal->probe; | 
|  | loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile; | 
|  | gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL); | 
|  | loc->section = sal->section; | 
|  | loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch; | 
|  | loc->line_number = sal->line; | 
|  | loc->symtab = sal->symtab; | 
|  |  | 
|  | set_breakpoint_location_function (loc, | 
|  | sal->explicit_pc || sal->explicit_line); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the | 
|  | code, we don't mark the location as inserted.  Normally one would expect | 
|  | that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program, | 
|  | thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing | 
|  | the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a | 
|  | SIGTRAP.  E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the | 
|  | instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies | 
|  | with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state".  Letting the | 
|  | breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB | 
|  | breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed. | 
|  | (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint, | 
|  | it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint | 
|  | instruction.)  */ | 
|  | if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc)) | 
|  | loc->permanent = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return loc; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | program_breakpoint_here_p (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int len; | 
|  | CORE_ADDR addr; | 
|  | const gdb_byte *bpoint; | 
|  | gdb_byte *target_mem; | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanup; | 
|  | int retval = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | addr = address; | 
|  | bpoint = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &len); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Software breakpoints unsupported?  */ | 
|  | if (bpoint == NULL) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | target_mem = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while | 
|  | we read the memory.  Otherwise we could say about our temporary | 
|  | breakpoints they are permanent.  */ | 
|  | cleanup = make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (target_read_memory (address, target_mem, len) == 0 | 
|  | && memcmp (target_mem, bpoint, len) == 0) | 
|  | retval = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanup); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return retval; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint, | 
|  | return 0 otherwise.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanup; | 
|  | int retval; | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (loc != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we have a catchpoint or a watchpoint, just return 0.  We should not | 
|  | attempt to read from the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types | 
|  | point to.  program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read | 
|  | memory.  */ | 
|  | if (!breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (loc->owner)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread (); | 
|  | switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace); | 
|  |  | 
|  | retval = program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address); | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanup); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return retval; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current | 
|  | settings of the dprintf style options.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string; | 
|  | char *printf_line = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!dprintf_args) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't | 
|  | insist on it.  */ | 
|  | if (*dprintf_args == ',') | 
|  | ++dprintf_args; | 
|  | dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (*dprintf_args != '"') | 
|  | error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0) | 
|  | printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args); | 
|  | else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!dprintf_function) | 
|  | error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0) | 
|  | printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)", | 
|  | dprintf_function, | 
|  | dprintf_channel, | 
|  | dprintf_args); | 
|  | else | 
|  | printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)", | 
|  | dprintf_function, | 
|  | dprintf_args); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ()) | 
|  | printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args); | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf")); | 
|  | printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, | 
|  | _("Invalid dprintf style.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL); | 
|  | /* Manufacture a printf sequence.  */ | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct command_line *printf_cmd_line = XNEW (struct command_line); | 
|  |  | 
|  | printf_cmd_line->control_type = simple_control; | 
|  | printf_cmd_line->body_count = 0; | 
|  | printf_cmd_line->body_list = NULL; | 
|  | printf_cmd_line->next = NULL; | 
|  | printf_cmd_line->line = printf_line; | 
|  |  | 
|  | breakpoint_set_commands (b, printf_cmd_line); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect | 
|  | current style settings.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | update_dprintf_commands (char *args, int from_tty, | 
|  | struct cmd_list_element *c) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_dprintf) | 
|  | update_dprintf_command_list (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location.  Use LOCATION | 
|  | as a description of the location, and COND_STRING | 
|  | as condition expression.  If LOCATION is NULL then create an | 
|  | "address location" from the address in the SAL.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines sals, | 
|  | struct event_location *location, | 
|  | char *filter, char *cond_string, | 
|  | char *extra_string, | 
|  | enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition, | 
|  | int thread, int task, int ignore_count, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty, | 
|  | int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags, | 
|  | int display_canonical) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int target_resources_ok; | 
|  |  | 
|  | i = hw_breakpoint_used_count (); | 
|  | target_resources_ok = | 
|  | target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint, | 
|  | i + 1, 0); | 
|  | if (target_resources_ok == 0) | 
|  | error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target.")); | 
|  | else if (target_resources_ok < 0) | 
|  | error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit.")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i]; | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal); | 
|  | if (!loc_gdbarch) | 
|  | loc_gdbarch = gdbarch; | 
|  |  | 
|  | describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch, | 
|  | sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (i == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops); | 
|  | b->thread = thread; | 
|  | b->task = task; | 
|  |  | 
|  | b->cond_string = cond_string; | 
|  | b->extra_string = extra_string; | 
|  | b->ignore_count = ignore_count; | 
|  | b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled; | 
|  | b->disposition = disposition; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0) | 
|  | b->loc->inserted = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (type == bp_static_tracepoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b; | 
|  | struct static_tracepoint_marker marker; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (strace_marker_p (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we | 
|  | wouldn't see a sal for it.  */ | 
|  | const char *p = &event_location_to_string (b->location)[3]; | 
|  | const char *endp; | 
|  | char *marker_str; | 
|  |  | 
|  | p = skip_spaces_const (p); | 
|  |  | 
|  | endp = skip_to_space_const (p); | 
|  |  | 
|  | marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p); | 
|  | t->static_trace_marker_id = marker_str; | 
|  |  | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint " | 
|  | "marker \"%s\"\n"), | 
|  | t->static_trace_marker_id); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | t->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id); | 
|  | release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker); | 
|  |  | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint " | 
|  | "marker \"%s\"\n"), | 
|  | t->static_trace_marker_id); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | warning (_("Couldn't determine the static " | 
|  | "tracepoint marker to probe")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | loc = b->loc; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal); | 
|  | if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0) | 
|  | loc->inserted = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (b->cond_string) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *arg = b->cond_string; | 
|  |  | 
|  | loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address, | 
|  | block_for_pc (loc->address), 0); | 
|  | if (*arg) | 
|  | error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), arg); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the | 
|  | command line, otherwise it's an error.  */ | 
|  | if (type == bp_dprintf) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b->extra_string) | 
|  | update_dprintf_command_list (b); | 
|  | else | 
|  | error (_("Format string required")); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (b->extra_string) | 
|  | error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | b->display_canonical = display_canonical; | 
|  | if (location != NULL) | 
|  | b->location = location; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *addr_string = NULL; | 
|  | int addr_string_len = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (location != NULL) | 
|  | addr_string = event_location_to_string (location); | 
|  | if (addr_string != NULL) | 
|  | addr_string_len = strlen (addr_string); | 
|  |  | 
|  | b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, | 
|  | addr_string, addr_string_len); | 
|  | } | 
|  | b->filter = filter; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines sals, | 
|  | struct event_location *location, | 
|  | char *filter, char *cond_string, | 
|  | char *extra_string, | 
|  | enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition, | 
|  | int thread, int task, int ignore_count, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty, | 
|  | int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags, | 
|  | int display_canonical) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (is_tracepoint_type (type)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct tracepoint *t; | 
|  |  | 
|  | t = new tracepoint (); | 
|  | b = &t->base; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | b = new breakpoint (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, b); | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_breakpoint_sal (b, gdbarch, | 
|  | sals, location, | 
|  | filter, cond_string, extra_string, | 
|  | type, disposition, | 
|  | thread, task, ignore_count, | 
|  | ops, from_tty, | 
|  | enabled, internal, flags, | 
|  | display_canonical); | 
|  | discard_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  |  | 
|  | install_breakpoint (internal, b, 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table.  For each | 
|  | SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i] | 
|  | value.  COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be | 
|  | used for all breakpoints.  Essentially the only case where | 
|  | SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded | 
|  | function.  In that case, it's still not possible to specify | 
|  | separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so | 
|  | we take just a single condition string. | 
|  |  | 
|  | NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup | 
|  | the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the | 
|  | array contents).  If the function fails (error() is called), the | 
|  | caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, | 
|  | COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
|  | char *cond_string, char *extra_string, | 
|  | enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition, | 
|  | int thread, int task, int ignore_count, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty, | 
|  | int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i; | 
|  | struct linespec_sals *lsal; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (canonical->pre_expanded) | 
|  | gdb_assert (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical->sals) == 1); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, i, lsal); ++i) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain | 
|  | 'break', without arguments.  */ | 
|  | struct event_location *location | 
|  | = (canonical->location != NULL | 
|  | ? copy_event_location (canonical->location) : NULL); | 
|  | char *filter_string = lsal->canonical ? xstrdup (lsal->canonical) : NULL; | 
|  | struct cleanup *inner = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location); | 
|  |  | 
|  | make_cleanup (xfree, filter_string); | 
|  | create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal->sals, | 
|  | location, | 
|  | filter_string, | 
|  | cond_string, extra_string, | 
|  | type, disposition, | 
|  | thread, task, ignore_count, ops, | 
|  | from_tty, enabled, internal, flags, | 
|  | canonical->special_display); | 
|  | discard_cleanups (inner); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly | 
|  | followed by conditionals.  On return, SALS contains an array of SAL | 
|  | addresses found.  LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for | 
|  | linespec locations). | 
|  |  | 
|  | The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is | 
|  | the caller's responsibility to free them.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | parse_breakpoint_sals (const struct event_location *location, | 
|  | struct linespec_result *canonical) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct symtab_and_line cursal; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *address = get_linespec_location (location); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (address == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default | 
|  | breakpoint address.  */ | 
|  | if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct linespec_sals lsal; | 
|  | struct symtab_and_line sal; | 
|  | CORE_ADDR pc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_sal (&sal);		/* Initialize to zeroes.  */ | 
|  | lsal.sals.sals = XNEW (struct symtab_and_line); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values | 
|  | corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. | 
|  | Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0 | 
|  | as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise. | 
|  | find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back.  */ | 
|  | get_last_displayed_sal (&sal); | 
|  | pc = sal.pc; | 
|  | sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC" | 
|  | where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address.  So | 
|  | make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from | 
|  | trying to expand the list of sals to include all other | 
|  | instances with the same symtab and line.  */ | 
|  | sal.pc = pc; | 
|  | sal.explicit_pc = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | lsal.sals.sals[0] = sal; | 
|  | lsal.sals.nelts = 1; | 
|  | lsal.canonical = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | error (_("No default breakpoint address now.")); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the | 
|  | current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default). | 
|  | This should produce the results we want almost all of the | 
|  | time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone. | 
|  |  | 
|  | ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which | 
|  | may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['.  */ | 
|  | cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line (); | 
|  | if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *address = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION) | 
|  | address = get_linespec_location (location); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!cursal.symtab | 
|  | || (address != NULL | 
|  | && strchr ("+-", address[0]) != NULL | 
|  | && address[1] != '[')) | 
|  | { | 
|  | decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL, | 
|  | get_last_displayed_symtab (), | 
|  | get_last_displayed_line (), | 
|  | canonical, NULL, NULL); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL, | 
|  | cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Convert each SAL into a real PC.  Verify that the PC can be | 
|  | inserted as a breakpoint.  If it can't throw an error.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++) | 
|  | resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations.  For | 
|  | instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will | 
|  | likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can | 
|  | only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a | 
|  | multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of | 
|  | it, etc.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines *sals) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i, rslt; | 
|  | struct symtab_and_line *sal; | 
|  | char *msg; | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct gdbarch *sarch; | 
|  |  | 
|  | sal = &sals->sals[i]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | sarch = get_sal_arch (*sal); | 
|  | /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture | 
|  | associated with SAL.  */ | 
|  | if (sarch == NULL) | 
|  | sarch = gdbarch; | 
|  | rslt = gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal->pc, &msg); | 
|  | old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, msg); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!rslt) | 
|  | error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at %s%s"), | 
|  | paddress (sarch, sal->pc), (msg ? msg : "")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as | 
|  | accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition | 
|  | string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD. | 
|  | PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed. | 
|  | If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL. | 
|  | If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc, | 
|  | char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task, | 
|  | char **rest) | 
|  | { | 
|  | *cond_string = NULL; | 
|  | *thread = -1; | 
|  | *task = 0; | 
|  | *rest = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | while (tok && *tok) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *end_tok; | 
|  | int toklen; | 
|  | const char *cond_start = NULL; | 
|  | const char *cond_end = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | tok = skip_spaces_const (tok); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest) | 
|  | { | 
|  | *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok)); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | end_tok = skip_to_space_const (tok); | 
|  |  | 
|  | toklen = end_tok - tok; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1; | 
|  | parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0); | 
|  | cond_end = tok; | 
|  | *cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *tmptok; | 
|  | struct thread_info *thr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | tok = end_tok + 1; | 
|  | thr = parse_thread_id (tok, &tmptok); | 
|  | if (tok == tmptok) | 
|  | error (_("Junk after thread keyword.")); | 
|  | *thread = thr->global_num; | 
|  | tok = tmptok; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *tmptok; | 
|  |  | 
|  | tok = end_tok + 1; | 
|  | *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0); | 
|  | if (tok == tmptok) | 
|  | error (_("Junk after task keyword.")); | 
|  | if (!valid_task_id (*task)) | 
|  | error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task); | 
|  | tok = tmptok; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (rest) | 
|  | { | 
|  | *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok)); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | error (_("Junk at end of arguments.")); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct symtabs_and_lines | 
|  | decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p) | 
|  | { | 
|  | VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers = NULL; | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines sals; | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain; | 
|  | const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3]; | 
|  | const char *endp; | 
|  | char *marker_str; | 
|  | int i; | 
|  |  | 
|  | p = skip_spaces_const (p); | 
|  |  | 
|  | endp = skip_to_space_const (p); | 
|  |  | 
|  | marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p); | 
|  | old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, marker_str); | 
|  |  | 
|  | markers = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str); | 
|  | if (VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers)) | 
|  | error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"), marker_str); | 
|  |  | 
|  | sals.nelts = VEC_length(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers); | 
|  | sals.sals = XNEWVEC (struct symtab_and_line, sals.nelts); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct static_tracepoint_marker *marker; | 
|  |  | 
|  | marker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, i); | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_sal (&sals.sals[i]); | 
|  |  | 
|  | sals.sals[i] = find_pc_line (marker->address, 0); | 
|  | sals.sals[i].pc = marker->address; | 
|  |  | 
|  | release_static_tracepoint_marker (marker); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  |  | 
|  | *arg_p = endp; | 
|  | return sals; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | const struct event_location *location, char *cond_string, | 
|  | int thread, char *extra_string, | 
|  | int parse_extra, | 
|  | int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted, | 
|  | int ignore_count, | 
|  | enum auto_boolean pending_break_support, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, | 
|  | int from_tty, int enabled, int internal, | 
|  | unsigned flags) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct linespec_result canonical; | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain; | 
|  | struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL; | 
|  | int pending = 0; | 
|  | int task = 0; | 
|  | int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count; | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (ops != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL.  */ | 
|  | if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0') | 
|  | extra_string = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_linespec_result (&canonical); | 
|  |  | 
|  | TRY | 
|  | { | 
|  | ops->create_sals_from_location (location, &canonical, type_wanted); | 
|  | } | 
|  | CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set | 
|  | value.  */ | 
|  | if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw | 
|  | error.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE) | 
|  | throw_exception (e); | 
|  |  | 
|  | exception_print (gdb_stderr, e); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user | 
|  | selects no, then simply return the error code.  */ | 
|  | if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO | 
|  | && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "), | 
|  | bptype_string (type_wanted))) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting | 
|  | a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending | 
|  | breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint | 
|  | is defaulted on behalf of the user.  */ | 
|  | pending = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | throw_exception (e); | 
|  | } | 
|  | END_CATCH | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!pending && VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical.sals)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up.  */ | 
|  | old_chain = make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* ----------------------------- SNIP ----------------------------- | 
|  | Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed | 
|  | to be part of a breakpoint.  If the breakpoint create succeeds | 
|  | then the memory is not reclaimed.  */ | 
|  | bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses | 
|  | are ok for the target.  */ | 
|  | if (!pending) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int ix; | 
|  | struct linespec_sals *iter; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, ix, iter); ++ix) | 
|  | breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&iter->sals); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location.  */ | 
|  | if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int ix; | 
|  | struct linespec_sals *iter; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, ix, iter); ++ix) | 
|  | check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, &iter->sals); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any | 
|  | breakpoints.  Allocate a separate condition expression for each | 
|  | breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | if (!pending) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (parse_extra) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *rest; | 
|  | struct linespec_sals *lsal; | 
|  |  | 
|  | lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition | 
|  | from thread number, so parsing in context of first | 
|  | sal is OK.  When setting the breakpoint we'll | 
|  | re-parse it in context of each sal.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | find_condition_and_thread (extra_string, lsal->sals.sals[0].pc, | 
|  | &cond_string, &thread, &task, &rest); | 
|  | if (cond_string) | 
|  | make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string); | 
|  | if (rest) | 
|  | make_cleanup (xfree, rest); | 
|  | if (rest) | 
|  | extra_string = rest; | 
|  | else | 
|  | extra_string = NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf | 
|  | && extra_string != NULL && *extra_string != '\0') | 
|  | error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Create a private copy of condition string.  */ | 
|  | if (cond_string) | 
|  | { | 
|  | cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string); | 
|  | make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string); | 
|  | } | 
|  | /* Create a private copy of any extra string.  */ | 
|  | if (extra_string) | 
|  | { | 
|  | extra_string = xstrdup (extra_string); | 
|  | make_cleanup (xfree, extra_string); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical, | 
|  | cond_string, extra_string, type_wanted, | 
|  | tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch, | 
|  | thread, task, ignore_count, ops, | 
|  | from_tty, enabled, internal, flags); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (is_tracepoint_type (type_wanted)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct tracepoint *t; | 
|  |  | 
|  | t = new tracepoint (); | 
|  | b = &t->base; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | b = new breakpoint (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, type_wanted, ops); | 
|  | b->location = copy_event_location (location); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (parse_extra) | 
|  | b->cond_string = NULL; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Create a private copy of condition string.  */ | 
|  | if (cond_string) | 
|  | { | 
|  | cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string); | 
|  | make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string); | 
|  | } | 
|  | b->cond_string = cond_string; | 
|  | b->thread = thread; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Create a private copy of any extra string.  */ | 
|  | if (extra_string != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | extra_string = xstrdup (extra_string); | 
|  | make_cleanup (xfree, extra_string); | 
|  | } | 
|  | b->extra_string = extra_string; | 
|  | b->ignore_count = ignore_count; | 
|  | b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch; | 
|  | b->condition_not_parsed = 1; | 
|  | b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled; | 
|  | if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint | 
|  | && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1) | 
|  | b->pspace = current_program_space; | 
|  |  | 
|  | install_breakpoint (internal, b, 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) > 1) | 
|  | { | 
|  | warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the " | 
|  | "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints.")); | 
|  | prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* That's it.  Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the | 
|  | breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain); | 
|  | /* But cleanup everything else.  */ | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded.  */ | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set a breakpoint. | 
|  | ARG is a string describing breakpoint address, | 
|  | condition, and thread. | 
|  | FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on, | 
|  | and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG | 
|  | and BP_TEMPFLAG.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG; | 
|  | enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG | 
|  | ? bp_hardware_breakpoint | 
|  | : bp_breakpoint); | 
|  | struct breakpoint_ops *ops; | 
|  | struct event_location *location; | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanup; | 
|  |  | 
|  | location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language); | 
|  | cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Matching breakpoints on probes.  */ | 
|  | if (location != NULL | 
|  | && event_location_type (location) == PROBE_LOCATION) | 
|  | ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | else | 
|  | ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | 
|  | location, | 
|  | NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */, | 
|  | tempflag, type_wanted, | 
|  | 0 /* Ignore count */, | 
|  | pending_break_support, | 
|  | ops, | 
|  | from_tty, | 
|  | 1 /* enabled */, | 
|  | 0 /* internal */, | 
|  | 0); | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanup); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal) | 
|  | { | 
|  | CORE_ADDR pc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc)) | 
|  | error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."), | 
|  | sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab)); | 
|  | sal->pc = pc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line | 
|  | number, then skip the function prologue if necessary.  */ | 
|  | if (sal->explicit_line) | 
|  | skip_prologue_sal (sal); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const struct blockvector *bv; | 
|  | const struct block *b; | 
|  | struct symbol *sym; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, | 
|  | SYMTAB_COMPUNIT (sal->symtab)); | 
|  | if (bv != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | sym = block_linkage_function (b); | 
|  | if (sym != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fixup_symbol_section (sym, SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab)); | 
|  | sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab), | 
|  | sym); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll | 
|  | just have to look harder. This case can be executed | 
|  | if we have line numbers but no functions (as can | 
|  | happen in assembly source).  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct bound_minimal_symbol msym; | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace); | 
|  |  | 
|  | msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc); | 
|  | if (msym.minsym) | 
|  | sal->section = MSYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym.objfile, msym.minsym); | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | break_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\ | 
|  | Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\ | 
|  | stop at <line>\n")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int badInput = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (arg == (char *) NULL) | 
|  | badInput = 1; | 
|  | else if (*arg != '*') | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *argptr = arg; | 
|  | int hasColon = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Look for a ':'.  If this is a line number specification, then | 
|  | say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or | 
|  | function/method name.  */ | 
|  | while (*argptr && !hasColon) | 
|  | { | 
|  | hasColon = (*argptr == ':'); | 
|  | argptr++; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (hasColon) | 
|  | badInput = (*argptr != ':');	/* Not a class::method */ | 
|  | else | 
|  | badInput = isdigit (*arg);	/* a simple line number */ | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (badInput) | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n")); | 
|  | else | 
|  | break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int badInput = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*')	/* no line number */ | 
|  | badInput = 1; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *argptr = arg; | 
|  | int hasColon = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Look for a ':'.  If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise | 
|  | it is probably a line number.  */ | 
|  | while (*argptr && !hasColon) | 
|  | { | 
|  | hasColon = (*argptr == ':'); | 
|  | argptr++; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (hasColon) | 
|  | badInput = (*argptr == ':');	/* we have class::method */ | 
|  | else | 
|  | badInput = !isdigit (*arg);	/* not a line number */ | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (badInput) | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n")); | 
|  | else | 
|  | break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but | 
|  | with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command, | 
|  | built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command | 
|  | line.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | dprintf_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct event_location *location; | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanup; | 
|  |  | 
|  | location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language); | 
|  | cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location; | 
|  | the next character must be ','.  */ | 
|  | if (arg != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0') | 
|  | error (_("Format string required")); | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Skip the comma.  */ | 
|  | ++arg; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | 
|  | location, | 
|  | NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */, | 
|  | 0, bp_dprintf, | 
|  | 0 /* Ignore count */, | 
|  | pending_break_support, | 
|  | &dprintf_breakpoint_ops, | 
|  | from_tty, | 
|  | 1 /* enabled */, | 
|  | 0 /* internal */, | 
|  | 0); | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanup); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | agent_printf_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
|  | const struct target_waitstatus *ws) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED | 
|  | || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address, | 
|  | bl->length, aspace, bp_addr); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return target_ranged_break_num_registers (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum print_stop_action | 
|  | print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl = b->loc; | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location.  */ | 
|  | gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | annotate_breakpoint (b->number); | 
|  |  | 
|  | maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (b->disposition == disp_del) | 
|  | uiout->text ("Temporary ranged breakpoint "); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->text ("Ranged breakpoint "); | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | { | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("reason", | 
|  | async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT)); | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number); | 
|  | uiout->text (", "); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | struct bp_location **last_loc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl = b->loc; | 
|  | struct value_print_options opts; | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location.  */ | 
|  | gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | get_user_print_options (&opts); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (opts.addressprint) | 
|  | /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later | 
|  | by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | uiout->field_skip ("addr"); | 
|  | annotate_field (5); | 
|  | print_breakpoint_location (b, bl); | 
|  | *last_loc = bl; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout) | 
|  | { | 
|  | CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end; | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl = b->loc; | 
|  | struct ui_file *stb = mem_fileopen (); | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb); | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (bl); | 
|  |  | 
|  | address_start = bl->address; | 
|  | address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | uiout->text ("\taddress range: "); | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (stb, "[%s, %s]", | 
|  | print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start), | 
|  | print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end)); | 
|  | uiout->field_stream ("addr", stb); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\n"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanup); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl = b->loc; | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (bl); | 
|  | gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."), | 
|  | b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address), | 
|  | paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s", | 
|  | event_location_to_string (b->location), | 
|  | event_location_to_string (b->location_range_end)); | 
|  | print_recreate_thread (b, fp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be | 
|  | placed, given the SAL of the end of the range.  This is so that if | 
|  | the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the | 
|  | last instruction of the given line.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static CORE_ADDR | 
|  | find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal) | 
|  | { | 
|  | CORE_ADDR end; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If the user provided a PC value, use it.  Otherwise, | 
|  | find the address of the end of the given location.  */ | 
|  | if (sal.explicit_pc) | 
|  | end = sal.pc; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | int ret; | 
|  | CORE_ADDR start; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end); | 
|  | if (!ret) | 
|  | error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line.  */ | 
|  | end--; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return end; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | break_range_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *arg_start, *addr_string_start; | 
|  | struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end; | 
|  | int bp_count, can_use_bp, length; | 
|  | CORE_ADDR end; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | struct symtab_and_line sal_start, sal_end; | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanup_bkpt; | 
|  | struct linespec_sals *lsal_start, *lsal_end; | 
|  | struct event_location *start_location, *end_location; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0) | 
|  | error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count (); | 
|  | bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers (); | 
|  | can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint, | 
|  | bp_count, 0); | 
|  | if (can_use_bp < 0) | 
|  | error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | arg = skip_spaces (arg); | 
|  | if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0') | 
|  | error(_("No address range specified.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_linespec_result (&canonical_start); | 
|  |  | 
|  | arg_start = arg; | 
|  | start_location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language); | 
|  | cleanup_bkpt = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (start_location); | 
|  | parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location, &canonical_start); | 
|  | make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical_start); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (arg[0] != ',') | 
|  | error (_("Too few arguments.")); | 
|  | else if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals)) | 
|  | error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | lsal_start = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals) > 1 | 
|  | || lsal_start->sals.nelts != 1) | 
|  | error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | sal_start = lsal_start->sals.sals[0]; | 
|  | addr_string_start = savestring (arg_start, arg - arg_start); | 
|  | make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string_start); | 
|  |  | 
|  | arg++;	/* Skip the comma.  */ | 
|  | arg = skip_spaces (arg); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Parse the end location.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_linespec_result (&canonical_end); | 
|  | arg_start = arg; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using | 
|  | parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's | 
|  | symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the | 
|  | range.  This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14", | 
|  | where +14 means 14 lines from the start location.  */ | 
|  | end_location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language); | 
|  | make_cleanup_delete_event_location (end_location); | 
|  | decode_line_full (end_location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL, | 
|  | sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line, | 
|  | &canonical_end, NULL, NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical_end); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals)) | 
|  | error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | lsal_end = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals, 0); | 
|  | if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals) > 1 | 
|  | || lsal_end->sals.nelts != 1) | 
|  | error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | sal_end = lsal_end->sals.sals[0]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end); | 
|  | if (sal_start.pc > end) | 
|  | error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | length = end - sal_start.pc + 1; | 
|  | if (length < 0) | 
|  | /* Length overflowed.  */ | 
|  | error (_("Address range too large.")); | 
|  | else if (length == 1) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* This range is simple enough to be handled by | 
|  | the `hbreak' command.  */ | 
|  | hbreak_command (addr_string_start, 1); | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanup_bkpt); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Now set up the breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start, | 
|  | bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  | set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1); | 
|  | b->number = breakpoint_count; | 
|  | b->disposition = disp_donttouch; | 
|  | b->location = copy_event_location (start_location); | 
|  | b->location_range_end = copy_event_location (end_location); | 
|  | b->loc->length = length; | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanup_bkpt); | 
|  |  | 
|  | mention (b); | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b); | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /*  Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant.  Returned zero | 
|  | means EXP is variable.  Also the constant detection may fail for | 
|  | some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return | 
|  | zero.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i = exp->nelts; | 
|  |  | 
|  | while (i > 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int oplenp, argsp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element.  */ | 
|  | operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp); | 
|  | i -= oplenp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (exp->elts[i].opcode) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case BINOP_ADD: | 
|  | case BINOP_SUB: | 
|  | case BINOP_MUL: | 
|  | case BINOP_DIV: | 
|  | case BINOP_REM: | 
|  | case BINOP_MOD: | 
|  | case BINOP_LSH: | 
|  | case BINOP_RSH: | 
|  | case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND: | 
|  | case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR: | 
|  | case BINOP_BITWISE_AND: | 
|  | case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR: | 
|  | case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR: | 
|  | case BINOP_EQUAL: | 
|  | case BINOP_NOTEQUAL: | 
|  | case BINOP_LESS: | 
|  | case BINOP_GTR: | 
|  | case BINOP_LEQ: | 
|  | case BINOP_GEQ: | 
|  | case BINOP_REPEAT: | 
|  | case BINOP_COMMA: | 
|  | case BINOP_EXP: | 
|  | case BINOP_MIN: | 
|  | case BINOP_MAX: | 
|  | case BINOP_INTDIV: | 
|  | case BINOP_CONCAT: | 
|  | case TERNOP_COND: | 
|  | case TERNOP_SLICE: | 
|  |  | 
|  | case OP_LONG: | 
|  | case OP_DOUBLE: | 
|  | case OP_DECFLOAT: | 
|  | case OP_LAST: | 
|  | case OP_COMPLEX: | 
|  | case OP_STRING: | 
|  | case OP_ARRAY: | 
|  | case OP_TYPE: | 
|  | case OP_TYPEOF: | 
|  | case OP_DECLTYPE: | 
|  | case OP_TYPEID: | 
|  | case OP_NAME: | 
|  | case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING: | 
|  |  | 
|  | case UNOP_NEG: | 
|  | case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT: | 
|  | case UNOP_COMPLEMENT: | 
|  | case UNOP_ADDR: | 
|  | case UNOP_HIGH: | 
|  | case UNOP_CAST: | 
|  |  | 
|  | case UNOP_CAST_TYPE: | 
|  | case UNOP_REINTERPRET_CAST: | 
|  | case UNOP_DYNAMIC_CAST: | 
|  | /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check | 
|  | their operands.  If they are constant, then so is the | 
|  | result of that operation.  For instance, if A and B are | 
|  | determined to be constants, then so is "A + B". | 
|  |  | 
|  | UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the | 
|  | value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when | 
|  | ADDR is.  */ | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case OP_VAR_VALUE: | 
|  | /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant. | 
|  |  | 
|  | We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's | 
|  | possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as | 
|  | constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return | 
|  | true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't. | 
|  |  | 
|  | We also have to check for function symbols because they | 
|  | are always constant.  */ | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK | 
|  | && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST | 
|  | && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using | 
|  | the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something, | 
|  | then it is not a constant.  */ | 
|  | default: | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | dtor_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *self) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) self; | 
|  |  | 
|  | xfree (w->exp_string); | 
|  | xfree (w->exp_string_reparse); | 
|  | value_free (w->val); | 
|  |  | 
|  | base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (self); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global | 
|  | variables, or it can be on local variables. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even | 
|  | persist across program restarts.  Since they can use variables | 
|  | from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries | 
|  | are loaded and unloaded. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result | 
|  | of solib event.  For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local | 
|  | and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint, | 
|  | but unloading of a shared library will make the expression | 
|  | invalid.  This is not a very common use case, but we still | 
|  | re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if | 
|  | watchpoints frame id is still valid.  If it's not, it means the | 
|  | watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon.  In fact, | 
|  | I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case. | 
|  |  | 
|  | If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then | 
|  | w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be | 
|  | reevaluated again when enabled.  */ | 
|  | update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner; | 
|  | int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type, | 
|  | w->cond_exp.get ()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner; | 
|  | int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type, | 
|  | w->cond_exp.get ()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
|  | const struct target_waitstatus *ws) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner; | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the | 
|  | reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on | 
|  | some data address).  Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction | 
|  | in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has | 
|  | been defined.  Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger | 
|  | (did not match the data address).  */ | 
|  | if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b) | 
|  | && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner; | 
|  | int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support.  */ | 
|  | return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum print_stop_action | 
|  | print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | struct ui_file *stb; | 
|  | enum print_stop_action result; | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w; | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
|  | w = (struct watchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | stb = mem_fileopen (); | 
|  | old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb); | 
|  |  | 
|  | annotate_watchpoint (b->number); | 
|  | maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (b->type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case bp_watchpoint: | 
|  | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | uiout->field_string | 
|  | ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | 
|  | mention (b); | 
|  | make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value"); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\nOld value = "); | 
|  | watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb); | 
|  | uiout->field_stream ("old", stb); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\nNew value = "); | 
|  | watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb); | 
|  | uiout->field_stream ("new", stb); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\n"); | 
|  | /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered.  */ | 
|  | result = PRINT_UNKNOWN; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | uiout->field_string | 
|  | ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | 
|  | mention (b); | 
|  | make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value"); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\nValue = "); | 
|  | watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb); | 
|  | uiout->field_stream ("value", stb); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\n"); | 
|  | result = PRINT_UNKNOWN; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
|  | if (bs->old_val != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | uiout->field_string | 
|  | ("reason", | 
|  | async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | 
|  | mention (b); | 
|  | make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value"); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\nOld value = "); | 
|  | watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb); | 
|  | uiout->field_stream ("old", stb); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\nNew value = "); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | mention (b); | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | uiout->field_string | 
|  | ("reason", | 
|  | async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | 
|  | make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value"); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\nValue = "); | 
|  | } | 
|  | watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb); | 
|  | uiout->field_stream ("new", stb); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\n"); | 
|  | result = PRINT_UNKNOWN; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | result = PRINT_UNKNOWN; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  | return result; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware | 
|  | watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cleanup *ui_out_chain; | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (b->type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case bp_watchpoint: | 
|  | uiout->text ("Watchpoint "); | 
|  | ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt"); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
|  | uiout->text ("Hardware watchpoint "); | 
|  | ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt"); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
|  | uiout->text ("Hardware read watchpoint "); | 
|  | ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt"); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
|  | uiout->text ("Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint "); | 
|  | ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt"); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, | 
|  | _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type.")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("number", b->number); | 
|  | uiout->text (": "); | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string); | 
|  | do_cleanups (ui_out_chain); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (b->type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case bp_watchpoint: | 
|  | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch"); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch"); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch"); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, | 
|  | _("Invalid watchpoint type.")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string); | 
|  | print_recreate_thread (b, fp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than | 
|  | GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP.  */ | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | masked hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask, | 
|  | bl->watchpoint_type); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | masked hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask, | 
|  | bl->watchpoint_type); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | masked hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | masked hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | masked hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum print_stop_action | 
|  | print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Masked watchpoints have only one location.  */ | 
|  | gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | annotate_watchpoint (b->number); | 
|  | maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (b->type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | uiout->field_string | 
|  | ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | uiout->field_string | 
|  | ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | uiout->field_string | 
|  | ("reason", | 
|  | async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, | 
|  | _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type.")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | mention (b); | 
|  | uiout->text (_("\n\ | 
|  | Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\ | 
|  | address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n")); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\n"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered.  */ | 
|  | return PRINT_UNKNOWN; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | masked hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Masked watchpoints have only one location.  */ | 
|  | gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | uiout->text ("\tmask "); | 
|  | uiout->field_core_addr ("mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | masked hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  | struct cleanup *ui_out_chain; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (b->type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
|  | uiout->text ("Masked hardware watchpoint "); | 
|  | ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt"); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
|  | uiout->text ("Masked hardware read watchpoint "); | 
|  | ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt"); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
|  | uiout->text ("Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint "); | 
|  | ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt"); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, | 
|  | _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type.")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("number", b->number); | 
|  | uiout->text (": "); | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string); | 
|  | do_cleanups (ui_out_chain); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | masked hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b; | 
|  | char tmp[40]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (b->type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch"); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_read_watchpoint: | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch"); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_access_watchpoint: | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch"); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, | 
|  | _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type.")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | sprintf_vma (tmp, w->hw_wp_mask); | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string, tmp); | 
|  | print_recreate_thread (b, fp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* accessflag:  hw_write:  watch write, | 
|  | hw_read:   watch read, | 
|  | hw_access: watch access (read or write) */ | 
|  | static void | 
|  | watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty, | 
|  | int just_location, int internal) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL; | 
|  | const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL; | 
|  | struct value *val, *mark, *result; | 
|  | int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0; | 
|  | struct frame_info *frame; | 
|  | const char *exp_start = NULL; | 
|  | const char *exp_end = NULL; | 
|  | const char *tok, *end_tok; | 
|  | int toklen = -1; | 
|  | const char *cond_start = NULL; | 
|  | const char *cond_end = NULL; | 
|  | enum bptype bp_type; | 
|  | int thread = -1; | 
|  | int pc = 0; | 
|  | /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for | 
|  | the hardware watchpoint.  */ | 
|  | int use_mask = 0; | 
|  | CORE_ADDR mask = 0; | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w; | 
|  | char *expression; | 
|  | struct cleanup *back_to; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse.  */ | 
|  | if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0') | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *value_start; | 
|  |  | 
|  | exp_end = arg + strlen (arg); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end | 
|  | of the arguments string.  */ | 
|  | for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list.  */ | 
|  | while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')) | 
|  | tok--; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Find the beginning of the last token. | 
|  | This is the value of the parameter.  */ | 
|  | while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t')) | 
|  | tok--; | 
|  | value_start = tok + 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Skip whitespace.  */ | 
|  | while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')) | 
|  | tok--; | 
|  |  | 
|  | end_tok = tok; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Find the beginning of the second to last token. | 
|  | This is the parameter itself.  */ | 
|  | while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t')) | 
|  | tok--; | 
|  | tok++; | 
|  | toklen = end_tok - tok + 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread")) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct thread_info *thr; | 
|  | /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means | 
|  | the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers | 
|  | only in a specific thread.  */ | 
|  | const char *endp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (thread != -1) | 
|  | error(_("You can specify only one thread.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Extract the thread ID from the next token.  */ | 
|  | thr = parse_thread_id (value_start, &endp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check if the user provided a valid thread ID.  */ | 
|  | if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0') | 
|  | invalid_thread_id_error (value_start); | 
|  |  | 
|  | thread = thr->global_num; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask")) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to | 
|  | create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask | 
|  | facility.  */ | 
|  | struct value *mask_value, *mark; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (use_mask) | 
|  | error(_("You can specify only one mask.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | use_mask = just_location = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | mark = value_mark (); | 
|  | mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start); | 
|  | mask = value_as_address (mask_value); | 
|  | value_free_to_mark (mark); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | /* We didn't recognize what we found.  We should stop here.  */ | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before | 
|  | the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function.  */ | 
|  | exp_end = tok; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | exp_end = arg; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Parse the rest of the arguments.  From here on out, everything | 
|  | is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original | 
|  | ARG.  */ | 
|  | innermost_block = NULL; | 
|  | expression = savestring (arg, exp_end - arg); | 
|  | back_to = make_cleanup (xfree, expression); | 
|  | exp_start = arg = expression; | 
|  | expression_up exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0); | 
|  | exp_end = arg; | 
|  | /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it. | 
|  | This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit | 
|  | prettier.  */ | 
|  | while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t')) | 
|  | --exp_end; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Checking if the expression is not constant.  */ | 
|  | if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp.get ())) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int len; | 
|  |  | 
|  | len = exp_end - exp_start; | 
|  | while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1])) | 
|  | len--; | 
|  | error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | exp_valid_block = innermost_block; | 
|  | mark = value_mark (); | 
|  | fetch_subexp_value (exp.get (), &pc, &val, &result, NULL, just_location); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (val != NULL && just_location) | 
|  | { | 
|  | saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val); | 
|  | saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (just_location) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int ret; | 
|  |  | 
|  | exp_valid_block = NULL; | 
|  | val = value_addr (result); | 
|  | release_value (val); | 
|  | value_free_to_mark (mark); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (use_mask) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val), | 
|  | mask); | 
|  | if (ret == -1) | 
|  | error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints.")); | 
|  | else if (ret == -2) | 
|  | error (_("Invalid mask or memory region.")); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (val != NULL) | 
|  | release_value (val); | 
|  |  | 
|  | tok = skip_spaces_const (arg); | 
|  | end_tok = skip_to_space_const (tok); | 
|  |  | 
|  | toklen = end_tok - tok; | 
|  | if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | innermost_block = NULL; | 
|  | tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1; | 
|  | parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition | 
|  | may still be.  E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'.  */ | 
|  | cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block; | 
|  |  | 
|  | cond_end = tok; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (*tok) | 
|  | error (_("Junk at end of command.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope" | 
|  | breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint | 
|  | expression.  Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so | 
|  | that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status.  */ | 
|  | if (exp_valid_block && frame) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | scope_breakpoint | 
|  | = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame), | 
|  | frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), | 
|  | bp_watchpoint_scope, | 
|  | &momentary_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  |  | 
|  | scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits.  */ | 
|  | scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion).  */ | 
|  | scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set the address at which we will stop.  */ | 
|  | scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch | 
|  | = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame); | 
|  | scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address | 
|  | = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame); | 
|  | scope_breakpoint->loc->address | 
|  | = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch, | 
|  | scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address, | 
|  | scope_breakpoint->type); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Now set up the breakpoint.  We create all watchpoints as hardware | 
|  | watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call | 
|  | to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to | 
|  | drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (accessflag == hw_read) | 
|  | bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint; | 
|  | else if (accessflag == hw_access) | 
|  | bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint; | 
|  | else | 
|  | bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint; | 
|  |  | 
|  | w = new watchpoint (); | 
|  | b = &w->base; | 
|  | if (use_mask) | 
|  | init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, NULL, bp_type, | 
|  | &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  | else | 
|  | init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, NULL, bp_type, | 
|  | &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  | b->thread = thread; | 
|  | b->disposition = disp_donttouch; | 
|  | b->pspace = current_program_space; | 
|  | w->exp = std::move (exp); | 
|  | w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block; | 
|  | w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block; | 
|  | if (just_location) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct type *t = value_type (val); | 
|  | CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val); | 
|  |  | 
|  | t = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (check_typedef (t))); | 
|  |  | 
|  | std::string name = type_to_string (t); | 
|  |  | 
|  | w->exp_string_reparse = xstrprintf ("* (%s *) %s", name.c_str (), | 
|  | core_addr_to_string (addr)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s", | 
|  | (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The above expression is in C.  */ | 
|  | b->language = language_c; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (use_mask) | 
|  | { | 
|  | w->hw_wp_mask = mask; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | w->val = val; | 
|  | w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos; | 
|  | w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize; | 
|  | w->val_valid = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (cond_start) | 
|  | b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start); | 
|  | else | 
|  | b->cond_string = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (frame) | 
|  | { | 
|  | w->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame); | 
|  | w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id; | 
|  | w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (scope_breakpoint != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint.  We will | 
|  | need to act on them together.  */ | 
|  | b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint; | 
|  | scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!just_location) | 
|  | value_free_to_mark (mark); | 
|  |  | 
|  | TRY | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Finally update the new watchpoint.  This creates the locations | 
|  | that should be inserted.  */ | 
|  | update_watchpoint (w, 1); | 
|  | } | 
|  | CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | throw_exception (e); | 
|  | } | 
|  | END_CATCH | 
|  |  | 
|  | install_breakpoint (internal, b, 1); | 
|  | do_cleanups (back_to); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression. | 
|  | If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int found_memory_cnt = 0; | 
|  | struct value *head = v; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */ | 
|  | if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon | 
|  | memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB.  If we | 
|  | find any register references or function calls, we can't use a | 
|  | hardware watchpoint. | 
|  |  | 
|  | The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series | 
|  | of values, one holding the value of every subexpression.  (The | 
|  | expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and | 
|  | a*b+c.)  GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish | 
|  | the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues, | 
|  | register lvalues, computed values, etcetera.  So we can evaluate | 
|  | the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves | 
|  | behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the | 
|  | expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints. | 
|  |  | 
|  | However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior | 
|  | function calls are special in any way.  So this function may not | 
|  | notice that an expression involving an inferior function call | 
|  | can't be watched with hardware watchpoints.  FIXME.  */ | 
|  | for (; v; v = value_next (v)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (v != head && value_lazy (v)) | 
|  | /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never | 
|  | needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g., | 
|  | `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a' | 
|  | in `a,b').  This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is | 
|  | lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway.  */ | 
|  | ; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Ahh, memory we actually used!  Check if we can cover | 
|  | it with hardware watchpoints.  */ | 
|  | struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it | 
|  | explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a | 
|  | middle of some value chain.  */ | 
|  | if (v == head | 
|  | || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT | 
|  | && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v); | 
|  | int len; | 
|  | int num_regs; | 
|  |  | 
|  | len = (target_exact_watchpoints | 
|  | && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))? | 
|  | 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len); | 
|  | if (!num_regs) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | else | 
|  | found_memory_cnt += num_regs; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval | 
|  | && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0) | 
|  | return 0;	/* These are values from the history (e.g., $1).  */ | 
|  | else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register) | 
|  | return 0;	/* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint.  */ | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware | 
|  | watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it.  */ | 
|  | return found_memory_cnt; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal) | 
|  | { | 
|  | watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then | 
|  | calls watch_command_1.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | watch_maybe_just_location (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int just_location = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (arg | 
|  | && (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1) | 
|  | || check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | arg = skip_spaces (arg); | 
|  | just_location = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal) | 
|  | { | 
|  | watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal) | 
|  | { | 
|  | watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands | 
|  | in infcmd.c.  Here because it uses the mechanisms of | 
|  | breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct until_break_fsm | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The base class.  */ | 
|  | struct thread_fsm thread_fsm; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The thread that as current when the command was executed.  */ | 
|  | int thread; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The breakpoint set at the destination location.  */ | 
|  | struct breakpoint *location_breakpoint; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame.  May be | 
|  | NULL.  */ | 
|  | struct breakpoint *caller_breakpoint; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void until_break_fsm_clean_up (struct thread_fsm *self, | 
|  | struct thread_info *thread); | 
|  | static int until_break_fsm_should_stop (struct thread_fsm *self, | 
|  | struct thread_info *thread); | 
|  | static enum async_reply_reason | 
|  | until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason (struct thread_fsm *self); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* until_break_fsm's vtable.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct thread_fsm_ops until_break_fsm_ops = | 
|  | { | 
|  | NULL, /* dtor */ | 
|  | until_break_fsm_clean_up, | 
|  | until_break_fsm_should_stop, | 
|  | NULL, /* return_value */ | 
|  | until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason, | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Allocate a new until_break_command_fsm.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct until_break_fsm * | 
|  | new_until_break_fsm (struct interp *cmd_interp, int thread, | 
|  | struct breakpoint *location_breakpoint, | 
|  | struct breakpoint *caller_breakpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct until_break_fsm *sm; | 
|  |  | 
|  | sm = XCNEW (struct until_break_fsm); | 
|  | thread_fsm_ctor (&sm->thread_fsm, &until_break_fsm_ops, cmd_interp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | sm->thread = thread; | 
|  | sm->location_breakpoint = location_breakpoint; | 
|  | sm->caller_breakpoint = caller_breakpoint; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return sm; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the | 
|  | until(location)/advance commands.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | until_break_fsm_should_stop (struct thread_fsm *self, | 
|  | struct thread_info *tp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct until_break_fsm *sm = (struct until_break_fsm *) self; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat, | 
|  | sm->location_breakpoint) != NULL | 
|  | || (sm->caller_breakpoint != NULL | 
|  | && bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat, | 
|  | sm->caller_breakpoint) != NULL)) | 
|  | thread_fsm_set_finished (self); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the | 
|  | until(location)/advance commands.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | until_break_fsm_clean_up (struct thread_fsm *self, | 
|  | struct thread_info *thread) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct until_break_fsm *sm = (struct until_break_fsm *) self; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | if (sm->location_breakpoint != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (sm->location_breakpoint); | 
|  | sm->location_breakpoint = NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (sm->caller_breakpoint != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (sm->caller_breakpoint); | 
|  | sm->caller_breakpoint = NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  | delete_longjmp_breakpoint (sm->thread); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the | 
|  | until(location)/advance commands.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum async_reply_reason | 
|  | until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason (struct thread_fsm *self) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines sals; | 
|  | struct symtab_and_line sal; | 
|  | struct frame_info *frame; | 
|  | struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch; | 
|  | struct frame_id stack_frame_id; | 
|  | struct frame_id caller_frame_id; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *location_breakpoint; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *caller_breakpoint = NULL; | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain, *cleanup; | 
|  | int thread; | 
|  | struct thread_info *tp; | 
|  | struct event_location *location; | 
|  | struct until_break_fsm *sm; | 
|  |  | 
|  | clear_proceed_status (0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from | 
|  | this function.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language); | 
|  | cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()) | 
|  | sals = decode_line_1 (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL, | 
|  | get_last_displayed_symtab (), | 
|  | get_last_displayed_line ()); | 
|  | else | 
|  | sals = decode_line_1 (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, | 
|  | NULL, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (sals.nelts != 1) | 
|  | error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | sal = sals.sals[0]; | 
|  | xfree (sals.sals);	/* malloc'd, so freed.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (*arg) | 
|  | error (_("Junk at end of arguments.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | resolve_sal_pc (&sal); | 
|  |  | 
|  | tp = inferior_thread (); | 
|  | thread = tp->global_num; | 
|  |  | 
|  | old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain. | 
|  | Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it | 
|  | may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before | 
|  | that.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | frame = get_selected_frame (NULL); | 
|  | frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame); | 
|  | stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame); | 
|  | caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current | 
|  | one.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct symtab_and_line sal2; | 
|  | struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch; | 
|  |  | 
|  | sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0); | 
|  | sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame); | 
|  | caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame); | 
|  | caller_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch, | 
|  | sal2, | 
|  | caller_frame_id, | 
|  | bp_until); | 
|  | make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (caller_breakpoint); | 
|  |  | 
|  | set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id); | 
|  | make_cleanup (delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup, &thread); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME.  */ | 
|  | frame = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (anywhere) | 
|  | /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location, | 
|  | we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop.  */ | 
|  | location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal, | 
|  | null_frame_id, bp_until); | 
|  | else | 
|  | /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop | 
|  | only at the very same frame.  */ | 
|  | location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal, | 
|  | stack_frame_id, bp_until); | 
|  | make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (location_breakpoint); | 
|  |  | 
|  | sm = new_until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp->global_num, | 
|  | location_breakpoint, caller_breakpoint); | 
|  | tp->thread_fsm = &sm->thread_fsm; | 
|  |  | 
|  | discard_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  |  | 
|  | proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT); | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanup); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause | 
|  | from the arg string.  If one is not found, it returns NULL. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string.  (It does not | 
|  | attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.)  And, | 
|  | it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed | 
|  | if clause in the arg string.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | char * | 
|  | ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *cond_string; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2])) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Skip the "if" keyword.  */ | 
|  | (*arg) += 2; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the | 
|  | condition string.  */ | 
|  | *arg = skip_spaces (*arg); | 
|  | cond_string = *arg; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg | 
|  | string.  */ | 
|  | (*arg) += strlen (cond_string); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cond_string; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions, | 
|  | process start/exit, etc.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | typedef enum | 
|  | { | 
|  | catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary, | 
|  | catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent | 
|  | } | 
|  | catch_fork_kind; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, | 
|  | struct cmd_list_element *command) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch (); | 
|  | char *cond_string = NULL; | 
|  | catch_fork_kind fork_kind; | 
|  | int tempflag; | 
|  |  | 
|  | fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command); | 
|  | tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary | 
|  | || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!arg) | 
|  | arg = ""; | 
|  | arg = skip_spaces (arg); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The allowed syntax is: | 
|  | catch [v]fork | 
|  | catch [v]fork if <cond> | 
|  |  | 
|  | First, check if there's an if clause.  */ | 
|  | cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg)) | 
|  | error (_("Junk at end of arguments.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint | 
|  | and enable reporting of such events.  */ | 
|  | switch (fork_kind) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case catch_fork_temporary: | 
|  | case catch_fork_permanent: | 
|  | create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, | 
|  | &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case catch_vfork_temporary: | 
|  | case catch_vfork_permanent: | 
|  | create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, | 
|  | &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it")); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, | 
|  | struct cmd_list_element *command) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct exec_catchpoint *c; | 
|  | struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch (); | 
|  | int tempflag; | 
|  | char *cond_string = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!arg) | 
|  | arg = ""; | 
|  | arg = skip_spaces (arg); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The allowed syntax is: | 
|  | catch exec | 
|  | catch exec if <cond> | 
|  |  | 
|  | First, check if there's an if clause.  */ | 
|  | cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg)) | 
|  | error (_("Junk at end of arguments.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = new exec_catchpoint (); | 
|  | init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, | 
|  | &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops); | 
|  | c->exec_pathname = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | struct symtab_and_line sal, | 
|  | char *addr_string, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, | 
|  | int tempflag, | 
|  | int enabled, | 
|  | int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal); | 
|  | if (!loc_gdbarch) | 
|  | loc_gdbarch = gdbarch; | 
|  |  | 
|  | describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch, | 
|  | sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1); | 
|  | /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special | 
|  | version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints | 
|  | used for different exception names will use the same address. | 
|  | In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is | 
|  | unproductive.  Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit | 
|  | inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell | 
|  | the user what type of catchpoint it is.  The above is good | 
|  | enough for now, though.  */ | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint, ops); | 
|  |  | 
|  | b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled; | 
|  | b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch; | 
|  | b->location = string_to_event_location (&addr_string, | 
|  | language_def (language_ada)); | 
|  | b->language = language_ada; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | error (_("Catch requires an event name.")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | error (_("Catch requires an event name.")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A qsort comparison function that sorts breakpoints in order.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | compare_breakpoints (const void *a, const void *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const breakpoint_p *ba = (const breakpoint_p *) a; | 
|  | uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) *ba; | 
|  | const breakpoint_p *bb = (const breakpoint_p *) b; | 
|  | uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) *bb; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((*ba)->number < (*bb)->number) | 
|  | return -1; | 
|  | else if ((*ba)->number > (*bb)->number) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with | 
|  | the number 0.  */ | 
|  | if (ua < ub) | 
|  | return -1; | 
|  | return ua > ub ? 1 : 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Delete breakpoints by address or line.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *prev; | 
|  | VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0; | 
|  | int ix; | 
|  | int default_match; | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines sals; | 
|  | struct symtab_and_line sal; | 
|  | int i; | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (arg) | 
|  | { | 
|  | sals = decode_line_with_current_source (arg, | 
|  | (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE | 
|  | | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE)); | 
|  | make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals); | 
|  | default_match = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | sals.sals = XNEW (struct symtab_and_line); | 
|  | make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals); | 
|  | init_sal (&sal);		/* Initialize to zeroes.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values | 
|  | corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.  If the | 
|  | codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0.  */ | 
|  | get_last_displayed_sal (&sal); | 
|  | if (sal.symtab == 0) | 
|  | error (_("No source file specified.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | sals.sals[0] = sal; | 
|  | sals.nelts = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | default_match = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here.  That's not as bad as it | 
|  | seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both | 
|  | file/line and pc set.  So, if clear is given file/line, we can | 
|  | match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all. | 
|  |  | 
|  | We only support clearing given the address explicitly | 
|  | present in breakpoint table.  Say, we've set breakpoint | 
|  | at file:line.  There were several PC values for that file:line, | 
|  | due to optimization, all in one block. | 
|  |  | 
|  | We've picked one PC value.  If "clear" is issued with another | 
|  | PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't | 
|  | be cleared.  We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but | 
|  | since the other PC value is never presented to user, user | 
|  | can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important | 
|  | to support that.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it.  Do | 
|  | it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that | 
|  | from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one | 
|  | breakpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | found = NULL; | 
|  | make_cleanup (VEC_cleanup (breakpoint_p), &found); | 
|  | for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *sal_fullname; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc. | 
|  | If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line. | 
|  | If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line | 
|  | or at default pc. | 
|  |  | 
|  | defaulting    sal.pc != 0    tests to do | 
|  |  | 
|  | 0              1             pc | 
|  | 1              1             pc _and_ line | 
|  | 0              0             line | 
|  | 1              0             <can't happen> */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | sal = sals.sals[i]; | 
|  | sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL | 
|  | ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int match = 0; | 
|  | /* Are we going to delete b?  */ | 
|  | if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc = b->loc; | 
|  | for (; loc; loc = loc->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC | 
|  | match.  This matches historical gdb behavior.  */ | 
|  | int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line | 
|  | && sal.pc | 
|  | && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace) | 
|  | && (loc->address == sal.pc) | 
|  | && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section) | 
|  | || loc->section == sal.section)); | 
|  | int line_match = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line) | 
|  | && loc->symtab != NULL | 
|  | && sal_fullname != NULL | 
|  | && sal.pspace == loc->pspace | 
|  | && loc->line_number == sal.line | 
|  | && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab), | 
|  | sal_fullname) == 0) | 
|  | line_match = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (pc_match || line_match) | 
|  | { | 
|  | match = 1; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (match) | 
|  | VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them.  */ | 
|  | if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (arg) | 
|  | error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg); | 
|  | else | 
|  | error (_("No breakpoint at this line.")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Remove duplicates from the vec.  */ | 
|  | qsort (VEC_address (breakpoint_p, found), | 
|  | VEC_length (breakpoint_p, found), | 
|  | sizeof (breakpoint_p), | 
|  | compare_breakpoints); | 
|  | prev = VEC_index (breakpoint_p, found, 0); | 
|  | for (ix = 1; VEC_iterate (breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ++ix) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b == prev) | 
|  | { | 
|  | VEC_ordered_remove (breakpoint_p, found, ix); | 
|  | --ix; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1) | 
|  | from_tty = 1;	/* Always report if deleted more than one.  */ | 
|  | if (from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1) | 
|  | printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint ")); | 
|  | else | 
|  | printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints ")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (from_tty) | 
|  | printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number); | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (from_tty) | 
|  | putchar_unfiltered ('\n'); | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanups); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and | 
|  | all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not. | 
|  | This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (; bs; bs = bs->next) | 
|  | if (bs->breakpoint_at | 
|  | && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del | 
|  | && bs->stop) | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop) | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to | 
|  | qsort.  Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what | 
|  | does breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER), | 
|  | secondarily by ordering first permanent elements and | 
|  | terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted stable way despite | 
|  | qsort being an unstable algorithm.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap; | 
|  | const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (a->address != b->address) | 
|  | return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping | 
|  | locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment) | 
|  | grouped.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num) | 
|  | return ((a->pspace->num > b->pspace->num) | 
|  | - (a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Sort permanent breakpoints first.  */ | 
|  | if (a->permanent != b->permanent) | 
|  | return (a->permanent < b->permanent) - (a->permanent > b->permanent); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs | 
|  | where A and B memory inside GDB can differ.  Breakpoint locations of | 
|  | the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number) | 
|  | return ((a->owner->number > b->owner->number) | 
|  | - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return (a > b) - (a < b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and | 
|  | bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current | 
|  | content of the bp_location array.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | bp_location_target_extensions_update (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0; | 
|  | bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | CORE_ADDR start, end, addr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | start = bl->target_info.placed_address; | 
|  | end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len; | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (bl->address >= start); | 
|  | addr = bl->address - start; | 
|  | if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max) | 
|  | bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (bl->address < end); | 
|  | addr = end - bl->address; | 
|  | if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max) | 
|  | bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | download_tracepoint_locations (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain; | 
|  | enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN; | 
|  |  | 
|  | old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl; | 
|  | struct tracepoint *t; | 
|  | int bp_location_downloaded = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint | 
|  | ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints | 
|  | : !may_insert_tracepoints)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (target_can_download_tracepoint ()) | 
|  | can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE; | 
|  | else | 
|  | can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE) | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so | 
|  | should_be_inserted is equivalent to | 
|  | unduplicated_should_be_inserted.  */ | 
|  | if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace); | 
|  |  | 
|  | target_download_tracepoint (bl); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bl->inserted = 1; | 
|  | bp_location_downloaded = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | t = (struct tracepoint *) b; | 
|  | t->number_on_target = b->number; | 
|  | if (bp_location_downloaded) | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const int left_inserted = left->inserted; | 
|  | const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate; | 
|  | const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update; | 
|  | const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated.  */ | 
|  | if (is_tracepoint (left->owner)) | 
|  | gdb_assert (!left->duplicate); | 
|  | if (is_tracepoint (right->owner)) | 
|  | gdb_assert (!right->duplicate); | 
|  |  | 
|  | left->inserted = right->inserted; | 
|  | left->duplicate = right->duplicate; | 
|  | left->needs_update = right->needs_update; | 
|  | left->target_info = right->target_info; | 
|  | right->inserted = left_inserted; | 
|  | right->duplicate = left_duplicate; | 
|  | right->needs_update = left_needs_update; | 
|  | right->target_info = left_target_info; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS.  This is called | 
|  | once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating | 
|  | conditions on the target's side.  Such conditions need to be updated on | 
|  | the target.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p; | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  | CORE_ADDR address = 0; | 
|  | int pspace_num; | 
|  |  | 
|  | address = bl->address; | 
|  | pspace_num = bl->pspace->num; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This is only meaningful if the target is | 
|  | evaluating conditions and if the user has | 
|  | opted for condition evaluation on the target's | 
|  | side.  */ | 
|  | if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () | 
|  | || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and | 
|  | the same program space as the location | 
|  | as "its condition has changed".  We need to | 
|  | update the conditions on the target's side.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, address) | 
|  | { | 
|  | loc = *loc2p; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner) | 
|  | || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Flag the location appropriately.  We use a different state to | 
|  | let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations | 
|  | with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace.  This is so | 
|  | we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations | 
|  | that have already been marked.  */ | 
|  | loc->condition_changed = condition_updated; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well.  We will compute | 
|  | it later on.  */ | 
|  | loc->cond_bytecode.reset (); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints | 
|  | deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which | 
|  | locations are duplicate of which. | 
|  |  | 
|  | The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or | 
|  | shall be inserted now.  See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more | 
|  | info.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | struct bp_location **locp, *loc; | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanups; | 
|  | /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update.  */ | 
|  | CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0; | 
|  | /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update.  */ | 
|  | int last_pspace_num = -1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Used in the duplicates detection below.  When iterating over all | 
|  | bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address. | 
|  | Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never | 
|  | duplicates of each other.  Keep one pointer for each type of | 
|  | breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations | 
|  | once.  */ | 
|  | struct bp_location *bp_loc_first;  /* breakpoint */ | 
|  | struct bp_location *wp_loc_first;  /* hardware watchpoint */ | 
|  | struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */ | 
|  | struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly | 
|  | built bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS.  */ | 
|  | struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp; | 
|  | unsigned old_location_count; | 
|  |  | 
|  | old_location = bp_location; | 
|  | old_location_count = bp_location_count; | 
|  | bp_location = NULL; | 
|  | bp_location_count = 0; | 
|  | cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next) | 
|  | bp_location_count++; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bp_location = XNEWVEC (struct bp_location *, bp_location_count); | 
|  | locp = bp_location; | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next) | 
|  | *locp++ = loc; | 
|  | qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location), | 
|  | bp_location_compare); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bp_location_target_extensions_update (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the | 
|  | new list, and therefore should be freed.  Note that it's not | 
|  | necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior -- | 
|  | if there's another location at the same address (previously | 
|  | marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the | 
|  | location. | 
|  |  | 
|  | LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current | 
|  | and former bp_location array state respectively.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | locp = bp_location; | 
|  | for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count; | 
|  | old_locp++) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp; | 
|  | struct bp_location **loc2p; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations.  If | 
|  | not, we have to free it.  */ | 
|  | int found_object = 0; | 
|  | /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target.  */ | 
|  | int keep_in_target = 0; | 
|  | int removed = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed. | 
|  | Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC.  */ | 
|  | while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count | 
|  | && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address) | 
|  | locp++; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (loc2p = locp; | 
|  | (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count | 
|  | && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address); | 
|  | loc2p++) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated | 
|  | location that had its condition modified.  If so, we want to send | 
|  | its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking | 
|  | place there.  */ | 
|  | if ((*loc2p)->condition_changed == condition_modified | 
|  | && (last_addr != old_loc->address | 
|  | || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | force_breakpoint_reinsertion (*loc2p); | 
|  | last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (*loc2p == old_loc) | 
|  | found_object = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't | 
|  | have to go through updates again.  */ | 
|  | last_addr = old_loc->address; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations.  */ | 
|  | if (!found_object) | 
|  | force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if | 
|  | there's maybe a new location at the same address.  If so, | 
|  | mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one.  This is | 
|  | needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint | 
|  | at certain location is not inserted.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (old_loc->inserted) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove | 
|  | it.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The location is still present in the location list, | 
|  | and still should be inserted.  Don't do anything.  */ | 
|  | keep_in_target = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the | 
|  | target since it may have been disabled.  We proceed to | 
|  | remove its target-side condition.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The location is either no longer present, or got | 
|  | disabled.  See if there's another location at the | 
|  | same address, in which case we don't need to remove | 
|  | this one from the target.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint.  */ | 
|  | if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (loc2p = locp; | 
|  | (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count | 
|  | && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address); | 
|  | loc2p++) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to | 
|  | access watchpoints, if the former are not | 
|  | supported, but the latter are.  */ | 
|  | if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner)); | 
|  | loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check | 
|  | if it should be inserted in case it will be | 
|  | unduplicated.  */ | 
|  | if (loc2 != old_loc | 
|  | && unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2); | 
|  | keep_in_target = 1; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!keep_in_target) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* This is just about all we can do.  We could keep | 
|  | this location on the global list, and try to | 
|  | remove it next time, but there's no particular | 
|  | reason why we will succeed next time. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still | 
|  | valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint | 
|  | only after calling us.  */ | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing " | 
|  | "breakpoint %d\n"), | 
|  | old_loc->owner->number); | 
|  | } | 
|  | removed = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!found_object) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p () | 
|  | && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* This location was removed from the target.  In | 
|  | non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where | 
|  | we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that | 
|  | breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later. | 
|  | We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such | 
|  | SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this | 
|  | breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it | 
|  | after we see some number of events.  The theory here | 
|  | is that reporting of events should, "on the average", | 
|  | be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all | 
|  | threads that have anything of interest, and no longer | 
|  | need to keep this breakpoint location around.  We | 
|  | don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of | 
|  | mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint | 
|  | SIGTRAP. | 
|  |  | 
|  | The heuristic failing can be disastrous on | 
|  | decr_pc_after_break targets. | 
|  |  | 
|  | On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux, | 
|  | if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP, | 
|  | because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too | 
|  | soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report | 
|  | a random SIGTRAP to the user.  When the user resumes | 
|  | the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash | 
|  | with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently | 
|  | corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the | 
|  | middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a | 
|  | one-byte instruction.  This was actually seen happen | 
|  | on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on | 
|  | targets that do not support new thread events, like | 
|  | remote, due to the heuristic depending on | 
|  | thread_count. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap | 
|  | causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when | 
|  | it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs | 
|  | behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Since hardware watchpoint traps are always | 
|  | distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to | 
|  | apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations | 
|  | around.  We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint | 
|  | traps we can no longer explain.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1); | 
|  | old_loc->owner = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | old_loc->owner = NULL; | 
|  | decref_bp_location (&old_loc); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the | 
|  | first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates".  This is so | 
|  | that the bpt instruction is only inserted once.  If we have a | 
|  | permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the | 
|  | official one, and the rest as duplicates.  Permanent breakpoints | 
|  | are sorted first for the same address. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the | 
|  | watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | bp_loc_first = NULL; | 
|  | wp_loc_first = NULL; | 
|  | awp_loc_first = NULL; | 
|  | rwp_loc_first = NULL; | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always | 
|  | non-NULL.  */ | 
|  | struct bp_location **loc_first_p; | 
|  | b = loc->owner; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc) | 
|  | || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b) | 
|  | /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are | 
|  | never duplicated.  See the comments in field `duplicate' of | 
|  | `struct bp_location'.  */ | 
|  | || is_tracepoint (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Clear the condition modification flag.  */ | 
|  | loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged; | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint) | 
|  | loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first; | 
|  | else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint) | 
|  | loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first; | 
|  | else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint) | 
|  | loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first; | 
|  | else | 
|  | loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (*loc_first_p == NULL | 
|  | || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section) | 
|  | || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | *loc_first_p = loc; | 
|  | loc->duplicate = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed) | 
|  | { | 
|  | loc->needs_update = 1; | 
|  | /* Clear the condition modification flag.  */ | 
|  | loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged; | 
|  | } | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location | 
|  | is not duplicated, and is the inserted one. | 
|  | All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted.  */ | 
|  | if (loc->inserted) | 
|  | swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p); | 
|  | loc->duplicate = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Clear the condition modification flag.  */ | 
|  | loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ()) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT) | 
|  | insert_breakpoint_locations (); | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new | 
|  | locations, we may still need to update conditions on the | 
|  | target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted | 
|  | if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions.  We | 
|  | only update conditions for locations that are marked | 
|  | "needs_update".  */ | 
|  | update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT) | 
|  | download_tracepoint_locations (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanups); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | breakpoint_retire_moribund (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  | int ix; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix) | 
|  | if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | decref_bp_location (&loc); | 
|  | VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix); | 
|  | --ix; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode) | 
|  | { | 
|  |  | 
|  | TRY | 
|  | { | 
|  | update_global_location_list (insert_mode); | 
|  | } | 
|  | CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR) | 
|  | { | 
|  | } | 
|  | END_CATCH | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Clear BKP from a BPS.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bpstat bs; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next) | 
|  | if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bs->breakpoint_at = NULL; | 
|  | bs->old_val = NULL; | 
|  | /* bs->commands will be freed later.  */ | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Callback for iterate_over_threads.  */ | 
|  | static int | 
|  | bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *bpt = (struct breakpoint *) data; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt); | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention | 
|  | callbacks.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | say_where (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct value_print_options opts; | 
|  |  | 
|  | get_user_print_options (&opts); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a | 
|  | single string.  */ | 
|  | if (b->loc == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based | 
|  | on b->extra_string.  If this is non-NULL, it contains either | 
|  | a condition or dprintf arguments.  */ | 
|  | if (b->extra_string == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."), | 
|  | event_location_to_string (b->location)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (b->type == bp_dprintf) | 
|  | { | 
|  | printf_filtered (_(" (%s,%s) pending."), | 
|  | event_location_to_string (b->location), | 
|  | b->extra_string); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | printf_filtered (_(" (%s %s) pending."), | 
|  | event_location_to_string (b->location), | 
|  | b->extra_string); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | printf_filtered (" at "); | 
|  | fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address), | 
|  | gdb_stdout); | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (b->loc->symtab != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If there is a single location, we can print the location | 
|  | more nicely.  */ | 
|  | if (b->loc->next == NULL) | 
|  | printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.", | 
|  | symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab), | 
|  | b->loc->line_number); | 
|  | else | 
|  | /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a | 
|  | different file name, and this at least reflects the | 
|  | real situation somewhat.  */ | 
|  | printf_filtered (": %s.", | 
|  | event_location_to_string (b->location)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (b->loc->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc = b->loc; | 
|  | int n = 0; | 
|  | for (; loc; loc = loc->next) | 
|  | ++n; | 
|  | printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Default bp_location_ops methods.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | bp_location_dtor (struct bp_location *self) | 
|  | { | 
|  | xfree (self->function_name); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static const struct bp_location_ops bp_location_ops = | 
|  | { | 
|  | bp_location_dtor | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Default breakpoint_ops methods all breakpoint_ops ultimately | 
|  | inherit from.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | base_breakpoint_dtor (struct breakpoint *self) | 
|  | { | 
|  | decref_counted_command_line (&self->commands); | 
|  | xfree (self->cond_string); | 
|  | xfree (self->extra_string); | 
|  | xfree (self->filter); | 
|  | delete_event_location (self->location); | 
|  | delete_event_location (self->location_range_end); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct bp_location * | 
|  | base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | loc = new struct bp_location (); | 
|  | init_bp_location (loc, &bp_location_ops, self); | 
|  | return loc; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Nothing to re-set. */ | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \ | 
|  | gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called") | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, | 
|  | enum remove_bp_reason reason) | 
|  | { | 
|  | internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
|  | const struct target_waitstatus *ws) | 
|  | { | 
|  | internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Always stop.   */ | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal | 
|  | errors.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal | 
|  | errors.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum print_stop_action | 
|  | base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self, | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* nothing */ | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location | 
|  | (const struct event_location *location, | 
|  | struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
|  | enum bptype type_wanted) | 
|  | { | 
|  | internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | struct linespec_result *c, | 
|  | char *cond_string, | 
|  | char *extra_string, | 
|  | enum bptype type_wanted, | 
|  | enum bpdisp disposition, | 
|  | int thread, | 
|  | int task, int ignore_count, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *o, | 
|  | int from_tty, int enabled, | 
|  | int internal, unsigned flags) | 
|  | { | 
|  | internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | base_breakpoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | const struct event_location *location, | 
|  | struct program_space *search_pspace, | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines *sals) | 
|  | { | 
|  | internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The default 'explains_signal' method.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The default "after_condition_true" method.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Nothing to do.   */ | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops = | 
|  | { | 
|  | base_breakpoint_dtor, | 
|  | base_breakpoint_allocate_location, | 
|  | base_breakpoint_re_set, | 
|  | base_breakpoint_insert_location, | 
|  | base_breakpoint_remove_location, | 
|  | base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit, | 
|  | base_breakpoint_check_status, | 
|  | base_breakpoint_resources_needed, | 
|  | base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode, | 
|  | base_breakpoint_print_it, | 
|  | NULL, | 
|  | base_breakpoint_print_one_detail, | 
|  | base_breakpoint_print_mention, | 
|  | base_breakpoint_print_recreate, | 
|  | base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location, | 
|  | base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal, | 
|  | base_breakpoint_decode_location, | 
|  | base_breakpoint_explains_signal, | 
|  | base_breakpoint_after_condition_true, | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Default breakpoint_ops methods.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* FIXME: is this still reachable?  */ | 
|  | if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Anything without a location can't be re-set.  */ | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | breakpoint_re_set_default (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | CORE_ADDR addr = bl->target_info.reqstd_address; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bl->target_info.kind = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr); | 
|  | bl->target_info.placed_address = addr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info); | 
|  | else | 
|  | return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info); | 
|  | else | 
|  | return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info, reason); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
|  | const struct target_waitstatus *ws) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED | 
|  | || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address, | 
|  | aspace, bp_addr)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (overlay_debugging		/* unmapped overlay section */ | 
|  | && section_is_overlay (bl->section) | 
|  | && !section_is_mapped (bl->section)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
|  | const struct target_waitstatus *ws) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent | 
|  | && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ()) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop.  If we see a trap | 
|  | for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to | 
|  | be set at the same address.  */ | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum print_stop_action | 
|  | bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | const struct bp_location *bl; | 
|  | int bp_temp; | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bl = bs->bp_location_at; | 
|  | b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del; | 
|  | if (bl->address != bl->requested_address) | 
|  | breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address, | 
|  | bl->address, | 
|  | b->number, 1); | 
|  | annotate_breakpoint (b->number); | 
|  | maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bp_temp) | 
|  | uiout->text ("Temporary breakpoint "); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->text ("Breakpoint "); | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | { | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("reason", | 
|  | async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT)); | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number); | 
|  | uiout->text (", "); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (b->type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case bp_breakpoint: | 
|  | case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver: | 
|  | if (b->disposition == disp_del) | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint")); | 
|  | else | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint")); | 
|  | printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number); | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver) | 
|  | printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver")); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_hardware_breakpoint: | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_dprintf: | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | say_where (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak"); | 
|  | else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break"); | 
|  | else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint | 
|  | && tp->disposition == disp_del) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak"); | 
|  | else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak"); | 
|  | else | 
|  | internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, | 
|  | _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type); | 
|  |  | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", | 
|  | event_location_to_string (tp->location)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending.  It might | 
|  | contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user.  */ | 
|  | if (tp->loc == NULL && tp->extra_string != NULL) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->extra_string); | 
|  |  | 
|  | print_recreate_thread (tp, fp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | bkpt_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location, | 
|  | struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
|  | enum bptype type_wanted) | 
|  | { | 
|  | create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
|  | char *cond_string, | 
|  | char *extra_string, | 
|  | enum bptype type_wanted, | 
|  | enum bpdisp disposition, | 
|  | int thread, | 
|  | int task, int ignore_count, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, | 
|  | int from_tty, int enabled, | 
|  | int internal, unsigned flags) | 
|  | { | 
|  | create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical, | 
|  | cond_string, extra_string, | 
|  | type_wanted, | 
|  | disposition, thread, task, | 
|  | ignore_count, ops, from_tty, | 
|  | enabled, internal, flags); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | bkpt_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | const struct event_location *location, | 
|  | struct program_space *search_pspace, | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines *sals) | 
|  | { | 
|  | decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace, sals); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch (b->type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they | 
|  | will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set.  */ | 
|  | case bp_overlay_event: | 
|  | case bp_longjmp_master: | 
|  | case bp_std_terminate_master: | 
|  | case bp_exception_master: | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior | 
|  | starts and we really don't want to touch it.  */ | 
|  | case bp_shlib_event: | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special.  Once | 
|  | it is set up, we do not want to touch it.  */ | 
|  | case bp_thread_event: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of | 
|  | events.  This allows the user to get control and place | 
|  | breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded | 
|  | objects (among other things).  */ | 
|  | bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events; | 
|  | bs->print = stop_on_solib_events; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | bs->stop = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum print_stop_action | 
|  | internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | b = bs->breakpoint_at; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (b->type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case bp_shlib_event: | 
|  | /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events | 
|  | variable?  (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due | 
|  | to shlib event" message.) */ | 
|  | print_solib_event (0); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bp_thread_event: | 
|  | /* Not sure how we will get here. | 
|  | GDB should not stop for these breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n")); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bp_overlay_event: | 
|  | /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these.  */ | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n")); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bp_longjmp_master: | 
|  | /* These should never be enabled.  */ | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n")); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bp_std_terminate_master: | 
|  | /* These should never be enabled.  */ | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: " | 
|  | "gdb should not stop!\n")); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bp_exception_master: | 
|  | /* These should never be enabled.  */ | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: " | 
|  | "gdb should not stop!\n")); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return PRINT_NOTHING; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Nothing to mention.  These breakpoints are internal.  */ | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step | 
|  | over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints. | 
|  | Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain | 
|  | or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable.  */ | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Nothing.  The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop.  */ | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum print_stop_action | 
|  | momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return PRINT_UNKNOWN; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Nothing to mention.  These breakpoints are internal.  */ | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists. | 
|  |  | 
|  | It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed | 
|  | breakpoints.  This is OK as they get all removed altogether.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | longjmp_bkpt_dtor (struct breakpoint *self) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct thread_info *tp = find_thread_global_id (self->thread); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (tp) | 
|  | tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id; | 
|  |  | 
|  | momentary_breakpoint_ops.dtor (self); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (v == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore | 
|  | if needed.  */ | 
|  | if (bl->probe.probe->pops->set_semaphore != NULL) | 
|  | bl->probe.probe->pops->set_semaphore (bl->probe.probe, | 
|  | bl->probe.objfile, | 
|  | bl->gdbarch); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return v; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, | 
|  | enum remove_bp_reason reason) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location.  */ | 
|  | if (bl->probe.probe->pops->clear_semaphore != NULL) | 
|  | bl->probe.probe->pops->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.probe, | 
|  | bl->probe.objfile, | 
|  | bl->gdbarch); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return bkpt_remove_location (bl, reason); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location, | 
|  | struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
|  | enum bptype type_wanted) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct linespec_sals lsal; | 
|  |  | 
|  | lsal.sals = parse_probes (location, NULL, canonical); | 
|  | lsal.canonical = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location)); | 
|  | VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | const struct event_location *location, | 
|  | struct program_space *search_pspace, | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines *sals) | 
|  | { | 
|  | *sals = parse_probes (location, search_pspace, NULL); | 
|  | if (!sals->sals) | 
|  | error (_("probe not found")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | breakpoint_re_set_default (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | 
|  | const struct target_waitstatus *ws) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at | 
|  | tracepoints.  */ | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self, | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self; | 
|  | if (tp->static_trace_marker_id) | 
|  | { | 
|  | gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint); | 
|  |  | 
|  | uiout->text ("\tmarker id is "); | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("static-tracepoint-marker-string-id", | 
|  | tp->static_trace_marker_id); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (b->type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case bp_tracepoint: | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint")); | 
|  | printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_fast_tracepoint: | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint")); | 
|  | printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case bp_static_tracepoint: | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint")); | 
|  | printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, | 
|  | _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | say_where (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace"); | 
|  | else if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace"); | 
|  | else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace"); | 
|  | else | 
|  | internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, | 
|  | _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type); | 
|  |  | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", | 
|  | event_location_to_string (self->location)); | 
|  | print_recreate_thread (self, fp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (tp->pass_count) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "  passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | tracepoint_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location, | 
|  | struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
|  | enum bptype type_wanted) | 
|  | { | 
|  | create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
|  | char *cond_string, | 
|  | char *extra_string, | 
|  | enum bptype type_wanted, | 
|  | enum bpdisp disposition, | 
|  | int thread, | 
|  | int task, int ignore_count, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, | 
|  | int from_tty, int enabled, | 
|  | int internal, unsigned flags) | 
|  | { | 
|  | create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical, | 
|  | cond_string, extra_string, | 
|  | type_wanted, | 
|  | disposition, thread, task, | 
|  | ignore_count, ops, from_tty, | 
|  | enabled, internal, flags); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | tracepoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | const struct event_location *location, | 
|  | struct program_space *search_pspace, | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines *sals) | 
|  | { | 
|  | decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace, sals); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be use on tracepoints placed in a | 
|  | static probe.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location | 
|  | (const struct event_location *location, | 
|  | struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
|  | enum bptype type_wanted) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes.  */ | 
|  | bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location, canonical, type_wanted); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | tracepoint_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | const struct event_location *location, | 
|  | struct program_space *search_pspace, | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines *sals) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes.  */ | 
|  | bkpt_probe_decode_location (b, location, search_pspace, sals); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | breakpoint_re_set_default (b); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf.  */ | 
|  | gdb_assert (b->extra_string != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands. | 
|  | 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine. | 
|  | 3 - disconnect from target 1 | 
|  | 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands. | 
|  |  | 
|  | After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to | 
|  | be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different | 
|  | answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands(). | 
|  | Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do | 
|  | it all the time.  */ | 
|  | if (b->extra_string != NULL) | 
|  | update_dprintf_command_list (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "dprintf %s,%s", | 
|  | event_location_to_string (tp->location), | 
|  | tp->extra_string); | 
|  | print_recreate_thread (tp, fp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for | 
|  | dprintf. | 
|  |  | 
|  | dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command | 
|  | list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the | 
|  | stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop.  This | 
|  | also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same | 
|  | address are all handled.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain; | 
|  | struct bpstats tmp_bs = { NULL }; | 
|  | struct bpstats *tmp_bs_p = &tmp_bs; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* dprintf's never cause a stop.  This wasn't set in the | 
|  | check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's | 
|  | condition not be evaluated.  */ | 
|  | bs->stop = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Run the command list here.  Take ownership of it instead of | 
|  | copying.  We never want these commands to run later in | 
|  | bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to | 
|  | be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the | 
|  | commands here throws.  */ | 
|  | tmp_bs.commands = bs->commands; | 
|  | bs->commands = NULL; | 
|  | old_chain = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&tmp_bs.commands); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but | 
|  | bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole | 
|  | list.  */ | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with | 
|  | markers (`-m').  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location, | 
|  | struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
|  | enum bptype type_wanted) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct linespec_sals lsal; | 
|  | const char *arg_start, *arg; | 
|  | char *str; | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanup; | 
|  |  | 
|  | arg = arg_start = get_linespec_location (location); | 
|  | lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg); | 
|  |  | 
|  | str = savestring (arg_start, arg - arg_start); | 
|  | cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, str); | 
|  | canonical->location = new_linespec_location (&str); | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanup); | 
|  |  | 
|  | lsal.canonical = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location)); | 
|  | VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
|  | char *cond_string, | 
|  | char *extra_string, | 
|  | enum bptype type_wanted, | 
|  | enum bpdisp disposition, | 
|  | int thread, | 
|  | int task, int ignore_count, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, | 
|  | int from_tty, int enabled, | 
|  | int internal, unsigned flags) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i; | 
|  | struct linespec_sals *lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals, | 
|  | canonical->sals, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id | 
|  | (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that | 
|  | breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly | 
|  | found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to | 
|  | expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS | 
|  | already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0; i < lsal->sals.nelts; ++i) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines expanded; | 
|  | struct tracepoint *tp; | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain; | 
|  | struct event_location *location; | 
|  |  | 
|  | expanded.nelts = 1; | 
|  | expanded.sals = &lsal->sals.sals[i]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | location = copy_event_location (canonical->location); | 
|  | old_chain = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location); | 
|  |  | 
|  | tp = new tracepoint (); | 
|  | init_breakpoint_sal (&tp->base, gdbarch, expanded, | 
|  | location, NULL, | 
|  | cond_string, extra_string, | 
|  | type_wanted, disposition, | 
|  | thread, task, ignore_count, ops, | 
|  | from_tty, enabled, internal, flags, | 
|  | canonical->special_display); | 
|  | /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with | 
|  | the same string id, if the user is creating a static | 
|  | tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then | 
|  | store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can | 
|  | try to match up which of the newly found markers | 
|  | corresponds to this one  */ | 
|  | tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i; | 
|  |  | 
|  | install_breakpoint (internal, &tp->base, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | discard_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | strace_marker_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | const struct event_location *location, | 
|  | struct program_space *search_pspace, | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines *sals) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b; | 
|  | const char *s = get_linespec_location (location); | 
|  |  | 
|  | *sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s); | 
|  | if (sals->nelts > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx) | 
|  | { | 
|  | sals->sals[0] = sals->sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx]; | 
|  | sals->nelts = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data | 
|  | structures.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (bpt != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Has this bp already been deleted?  This can happen because | 
|  | multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's.  bpstat lists are | 
|  | especial culprits. | 
|  |  | 
|  | One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp.  When | 
|  | the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of | 
|  | scope, and delete it.  We also delete its scope bp.  But the | 
|  | scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat. | 
|  | That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are | 
|  | deleted. | 
|  |  | 
|  | A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in | 
|  | bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing | 
|  | bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's | 
|  | storage when no more references were extent.  A cheaper bandaid | 
|  | was chosen.  */ | 
|  | if (bpt->type == bp_none) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting | 
|  | of breakpoints gets resolved.  */ | 
|  | if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *related; | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope) | 
|  | w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint; | 
|  | else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope) | 
|  | w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt; | 
|  | else | 
|  | w = NULL; | 
|  | if (w != NULL) | 
|  | watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring.  */ | 
|  | for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt; | 
|  | related = related->related_breakpoint); | 
|  | related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint; | 
|  | bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if | 
|  | update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations.  If there's | 
|  | a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created | 
|  | watchpoint.  In that case, don't announce the deletion.  */ | 
|  | if (bpt->number) | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (breakpoint_chain == bpt) | 
|  | breakpoint_chain = bpt->next; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | if (b->next == bpt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | b->next = bpt->next; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's | 
|  | been freed.  */ | 
|  | /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's?  We just check stop_bpstat | 
|  | in all threads for now.  Note that we cannot just remove bpstats | 
|  | pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint | 
|  | commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here, | 
|  | then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in | 
|  | event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with | 
|  | commands won't work.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the | 
|  | global location list.  This will remove locations that used to | 
|  | belong to this breakpoint.  Do this before freeing the breakpoint | 
|  | itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner.  It | 
|  | might be better design to have location completely | 
|  | self-contained, but it's not the case now.  */ | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bpt->ops->dtor (bpt); | 
|  | /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this | 
|  | same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage.  */ | 
|  | bpt->type = bp_none; | 
|  | delete bpt; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | delete_breakpoint ((struct breakpoint *) b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct cleanup * | 
|  | make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once | 
|  | for each of B and its related breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | void (*function) (struct breakpoint *, | 
|  | void *), | 
|  | void *data) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *related; | 
|  |  | 
|  | related = b; | 
|  | do | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *next; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED.  */ | 
|  | next = related->related_breakpoint; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (next == related) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* RELATED is the last ring entry.  */ | 
|  | function (related, data); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to | 
|  | B.  There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break | 
|  | out.  */ | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | function (related, data); | 
|  |  | 
|  | related = next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | while (related != b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | do_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore) | 
|  | { | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls | 
|  | delete_breakpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | do_map_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore) | 
|  | { | 
|  | iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_delete_breakpoint, NULL); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | dont_repeat (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (arg == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int breaks_to_delete = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.  Do not delete | 
|  | internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an | 
|  | explicit breakpoint number argument.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | if (user_breakpoint_p (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | breaks_to_delete = 1; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete.  */ | 
|  | if (!from_tty | 
|  | || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? ")))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp) | 
|  | if (user_breakpoint_p (b)) | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_delete_breakpoint, NULL); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending.  If | 
|  | PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are | 
|  | considered.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next) | 
|  | if ((pspace == NULL | 
|  | || loc->pspace == pspace) | 
|  | && !loc->shlib_disabled | 
|  | && !loc->pspace->executing_startup) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it. | 
|  | Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name. | 
|  | Null names are ignored.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *l; | 
|  | htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string, | 
|  | (int (*) (const void *, | 
|  | const void *)) streq, | 
|  | NULL, xcalloc, xfree); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char **slot; | 
|  | const char *name = l->function_name; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them.  */ | 
|  | if (name == NULL) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name, | 
|  | INSERT); | 
|  | /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never | 
|  | returns NULL.  */ | 
|  | if (*slot != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | htab_delete (htab); | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | *slot = name; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | htab_delete (htab); | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well, | 
|  | and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at | 
|  | the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we | 
|  | checked.  Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is | 
|  | undesirable.  This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static | 
|  | tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints | 
|  | that have not been set by marker id.  Static tracepoint that have | 
|  | been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set. | 
|  | The heuristic is: | 
|  |  | 
|  | 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at | 
|  | the old PC.  If one is found there, assume to be the same marker. | 
|  | If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the | 
|  | previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker | 
|  | in the sources, and output a warning. | 
|  |  | 
|  | 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker | 
|  | at the new address of the old line number.  If one is found there, | 
|  | assume to be the same marker.  If the name / string id of the | 
|  | marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that | 
|  | means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a | 
|  | warning. | 
|  |  | 
|  | 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it | 
|  | may mean the marker no longer exists.  But it may also just mean | 
|  | the code changed a bit.  Maybe the user added a few lines of code | 
|  | that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms).  Ask | 
|  | the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew | 
|  | it.  If found, update line number and address in the matching | 
|  | static tracepoint.  This will get confused if there's more than one | 
|  | marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised | 
|  | precisely because it confuses tools).  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct symtab_and_line | 
|  | update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b; | 
|  | struct static_tracepoint_marker marker; | 
|  | CORE_ADDR pc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | pc = sal.pc; | 
|  | if (sal.line) | 
|  | find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (strcmp (tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id) != 0) | 
|  | warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"), | 
|  | b->number, | 
|  | tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id); | 
|  |  | 
|  | xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id); | 
|  | tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id); | 
|  | release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return sal; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno.  Try looking it up | 
|  | by string ID.  */ | 
|  | if (!sal.explicit_pc | 
|  | && sal.line != 0 | 
|  | && sal.symtab != NULL | 
|  | && tp->static_trace_marker_id != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers; | 
|  |  | 
|  | markers | 
|  | = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (tp->static_trace_marker_id); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct symtab_and_line sal2; | 
|  | struct symbol *sym; | 
|  | struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker; | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  | struct explicit_location explicit_loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | tpmarker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id); | 
|  | tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (tpmarker->str_id); | 
|  |  | 
|  | warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not " | 
|  | "found at previous line number"), | 
|  | b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id); | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_sal (&sal2); | 
|  |  | 
|  | sal2.pc = tpmarker->address; | 
|  |  | 
|  | sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0); | 
|  | sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL); | 
|  | uiout->text ("Now in "); | 
|  | if (sym) | 
|  | { | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("func", SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym)); | 
|  | uiout->text (" at "); | 
|  | } | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("file", | 
|  | symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab)); | 
|  | uiout->text (":"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab); | 
|  |  | 
|  | uiout->field_string ("fullname", fullname); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | uiout->field_int ("line", sal2.line); | 
|  | uiout->text ("\n"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | b->loc->line_number = sal2.line; | 
|  | b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | delete_event_location (b->location); | 
|  | initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); | 
|  | explicit_loc.source_filename | 
|  | = ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab)); | 
|  | explicit_loc.line_offset.offset = b->loc->line_number; | 
|  | explicit_loc.line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE; | 
|  | b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if | 
|  | so.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | release_static_tracepoint_marker (tpmarker); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | return sal; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that | 
|  | we don't need to report breakpoint as changed.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | while (a && b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (a->address != b->address) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (a->enabled != b->enabled) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | a = a->next; | 
|  | b = b->next; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Split all locations of B that are bound to PSPACE out of B's | 
|  | location list to a separate list and return that list's head.  If | 
|  | PSPACE is NULL, hoist out all locations of B.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct bp_location * | 
|  | hoist_existing_locations (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location head; | 
|  | struct bp_location *i = b->loc; | 
|  | struct bp_location **i_link = &b->loc; | 
|  | struct bp_location *hoisted = &head; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (pspace == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | i = b->loc; | 
|  | b->loc = NULL; | 
|  | return i; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | head.next = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | while (i != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (i->pspace == pspace) | 
|  | { | 
|  | *i_link = i->next; | 
|  | i->next = NULL; | 
|  | hoisted->next = i; | 
|  | hoisted = i; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | i_link = &i->next; | 
|  | i = *i_link; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return head.next; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software | 
|  | breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END.  If SALS_END.NELTS is not | 
|  | zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint.  Only recreates locations for | 
|  | FILTER_PSPACE.  Locations of other program spaces are left | 
|  | untouched.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | struct program_space *filter_pspace, | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines sals, | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines sals_end) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i; | 
|  | struct bp_location *existing_locations; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (sals_end.nelts != 0 && (sals.nelts != 1 || sals_end.nelts != 1)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end | 
|  | location.  */ | 
|  | b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
|  | printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: " | 
|  | "multiple locations found\n"), | 
|  | b->number); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are | 
|  | pending, don't do anything.  This optimizes the common case where | 
|  | all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded. | 
|  | We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is | 
|  | loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the | 
|  | individual locations.  */ | 
|  | if (all_locations_are_pending (b, filter_pspace) && sals.nelts == 0) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | existing_locations = hoist_existing_locations (b, filter_pspace); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *new_loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sals.sals[i].pspace); | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i])); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the | 
|  | old symtab.  */ | 
|  | if (b->cond_string != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *s; | 
|  |  | 
|  | s = b->cond_string; | 
|  | TRY | 
|  | { | 
|  | new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sals.sals[i].pc, | 
|  | block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc), | 
|  | 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  | CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR) | 
|  | { | 
|  | warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition " | 
|  | "for breakpoint %d: %s"), | 
|  | b->number, e.message); | 
|  | new_loc->enabled = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | END_CATCH | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (sals_end.nelts) | 
|  | { | 
|  | CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end.sals[0]); | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_loc->length = end - sals.sals[0].pc + 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing | 
|  | breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *e = existing_locations; | 
|  | /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name, | 
|  | e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work. | 
|  | Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things | 
|  | may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer | 
|  | often enough until a better solution is found.  */ | 
|  | int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (; e; e = e->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!e->enabled && e->function_name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *l = b->loc; | 
|  | if (have_ambiguous_names) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (; l; l = l->next) | 
|  | if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | l->enabled = 0; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (; l; l = l->next) | 
|  | if (l->function_name | 
|  | && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | l->enabled = 0; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc)) | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION. | 
|  | On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct symtabs_and_lines | 
|  | location_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location, | 
|  | struct program_space *search_pspace, int *found) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0}; | 
|  | struct gdb_exception exception = exception_none; | 
|  |  | 
|  | gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | TRY | 
|  | { | 
|  | b->ops->decode_location (b, location, search_pspace, &sals); | 
|  | } | 
|  | CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int not_found_and_ok = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | exception = e; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will | 
|  | fail until the right shared library is loaded.  User has | 
|  | already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need | 
|  | extra messages.  If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled | 
|  | state, then user already saw the message about that | 
|  | breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more | 
|  | errors.  */ | 
|  | if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR | 
|  | && (b->condition_not_parsed | 
|  | || (b->loc != NULL | 
|  | && search_pspace != NULL | 
|  | && b->loc->pspace != search_pspace) | 
|  | || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled) | 
|  | || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup) | 
|  | || b->enable_state == bp_disabled)) | 
|  | not_found_and_ok = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!not_found_and_ok) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint | 
|  | 10 times.  One solution, implemented here, is disable | 
|  | the breakpoint on error.  Another solution would be to | 
|  | have separate 'warning emitted' flag.  Since this | 
|  | happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know | 
|  | which approach is better.  */ | 
|  | b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
|  | throw_exception (e); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | END_CATCH | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i) | 
|  | resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[i]); | 
|  | if (b->condition_not_parsed && b->extra_string != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *cond_string, *extra_string; | 
|  | int thread, task; | 
|  |  | 
|  | find_condition_and_thread (b->extra_string, sals.sals[0].pc, | 
|  | &cond_string, &thread, &task, | 
|  | &extra_string); | 
|  | gdb_assert (b->cond_string == NULL); | 
|  | if (cond_string) | 
|  | b->cond_string = cond_string; | 
|  | b->thread = thread; | 
|  | b->task = task; | 
|  | if (extra_string) | 
|  | { | 
|  | xfree (b->extra_string); | 
|  | b->extra_string = extra_string; | 
|  | } | 
|  | b->condition_not_parsed = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b)) | 
|  | sals.sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals.sals[0]); | 
|  |  | 
|  | *found = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | *found = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return sals; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software | 
|  | breakpoints.  Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its | 
|  | locations.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int found; | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines sals, sals_end; | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0}; | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines expanded_end = {0}; | 
|  | struct program_space *filter_pspace = current_program_space; | 
|  |  | 
|  | sals = location_to_sals (b, b->location, filter_pspace, &found); | 
|  | if (found) | 
|  | { | 
|  | make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals); | 
|  | expanded = sals; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (b->location_range_end != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | sals_end = location_to_sals (b, b->location_range_end, | 
|  | filter_pspace, &found); | 
|  | if (found) | 
|  | { | 
|  | make_cleanup (xfree, sals_end.sals); | 
|  | expanded_end = sals_end; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | update_breakpoint_locations (b, filter_pspace, expanded, expanded_end); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string.  It basically | 
|  | calls parse_breakpoint_sals.  Return 1 for success, zero for failure.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location, | 
|  | struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
|  | enum bptype type_wanted) | 
|  | { | 
|  | parse_breakpoint_sals (location, canonical); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments.  This is the default | 
|  | function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of | 
|  | breakpoint_ops.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | struct linespec_result *canonical, | 
|  | char *cond_string, | 
|  | char *extra_string, | 
|  | enum bptype type_wanted, | 
|  | enum bpdisp disposition, | 
|  | int thread, | 
|  | int task, int ignore_count, | 
|  | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, | 
|  | int from_tty, int enabled, | 
|  | int internal, unsigned flags) | 
|  | { | 
|  | create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical, cond_string, | 
|  | extra_string, | 
|  | type_wanted, disposition, | 
|  | thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, | 
|  | enabled, internal, flags); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full.  This is the | 
|  | default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b, | 
|  | const struct event_location *location, | 
|  | struct program_space *search_pspace, | 
|  | struct symtabs_and_lines *sals) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct linespec_result canonical; | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_linespec_result (&canonical); | 
|  | decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace, | 
|  | (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, | 
|  | &canonical, multiple_symbols_all, | 
|  | b->filter); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs.  */ | 
|  | gdb_assert (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) < 2); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) > 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct linespec_sals *lsal; | 
|  |  | 
|  | lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, 0); | 
|  | *sals = lsal->sals; | 
|  | /* Arrange it so the destructor does not free the | 
|  | contents.  */ | 
|  | lsal->sals.sals = NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | destroy_linespec_result (&canonical); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Prepare the global context for a re-set of breakpoint B.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct cleanup * | 
|  | prepare_re_set_context (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | input_radix = b->input_radix; | 
|  | set_language (b->language); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT. | 
|  | The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors. | 
|  | Unused in this case.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Get past catch_errs.  */ | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint; | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanups; | 
|  |  | 
|  | cleanups = prepare_re_set_context (b); | 
|  | b->ops->re_set (b); | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanups); | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space. | 
|  | Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | breakpoint_re_set (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp; | 
|  | enum language save_language; | 
|  | int save_input_radix; | 
|  | struct cleanup *old_chain; | 
|  |  | 
|  | save_language = current_language->la_language; | 
|  | save_input_radix = input_radix; | 
|  | old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all | 
|  | breakpoints have been re-set.  Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting | 
|  | breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which | 
|  | hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Format possible error msg.  */ | 
|  | char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ", | 
|  | b->number); | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message); | 
|  | catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL); | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanups); | 
|  | } | 
|  | set_language (save_language); | 
|  | input_radix = save_input_radix; | 
|  |  | 
|  | jit_breakpoint_re_set (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (old_chain); | 
|  |  | 
|  | create_overlay_event_breakpoint (); | 
|  | create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (); | 
|  | create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (); | 
|  | create_exception_master_breakpoint (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Now we can insert.  */ | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint: | 
|  |  | 
|  | - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is. | 
|  | - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid.  */ | 
|  | void | 
|  | breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b->thread != -1) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid)) | 
|  | b->thread = ptid_to_global_thread_id (inferior_ptid); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We're being called after following a fork.  The new fork is | 
|  | selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a | 
|  | different program space from the original thread.  Reset that | 
|  | as well.  */ | 
|  | b->loc->pspace = current_program_space; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT. | 
|  | If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect, | 
|  | which ends with a period (no newline).  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (count < 0) | 
|  | count = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | if (b->number == bptnum) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (is_tracepoint (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (from_tty && count != 0) | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."), | 
|  | bptnum); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | b->ignore_count = count; | 
|  | if (from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (count == 0) | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time " | 
|  | "breakpoint %d is reached."), | 
|  | bptnum); | 
|  | else if (count == 1) | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."), | 
|  | bptnum); | 
|  | else | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d " | 
|  | "crossings of breakpoint %d."), | 
|  | count, bptnum); | 
|  | } | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *p = args; | 
|  | int num; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (p == 0) | 
|  | error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | num = get_number (&p); | 
|  | if (num == 0) | 
|  | error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args); | 
|  | if (*p == 0) | 
|  | error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | set_ignore_count (num, | 
|  | longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))), | 
|  | from_tty); | 
|  | if (from_tty) | 
|  | printf_filtered ("\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints | 
|  | whose numbers are given in ARGS.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *args, | 
|  | void (*function) (struct breakpoint *, | 
|  | void *), | 
|  | void *data) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int num; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (args == 0 || *args == '\0') | 
|  | error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | number_or_range_parser parser (args); | 
|  |  | 
|  | while (!parser.finished ()) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *p = parser.cur_tok (); | 
|  | bool match = false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | num = parser.get_number (); | 
|  | if (num == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp) | 
|  | if (b->number == num) | 
|  | { | 
|  | match = true; | 
|  | function (b, data); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (!match) | 
|  | printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct bp_location * | 
|  | find_location_by_number (char *number) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *dot = strchr (number, '.'); | 
|  | char *p1; | 
|  | int bp_num; | 
|  | int loc_num; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | *dot = '\0'; | 
|  |  | 
|  | p1 = number; | 
|  | bp_num = get_number (&p1); | 
|  | if (bp_num == 0) | 
|  | error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | if (b->number == bp_num) | 
|  | { | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!b || b->number != bp_num) | 
|  | error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number); | 
|  |  | 
|  | p1 = dot+1; | 
|  | loc_num = get_number (&p1); | 
|  | if (loc_num == 0) | 
|  | error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number); | 
|  |  | 
|  | --loc_num; | 
|  | loc = b->loc; | 
|  | for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next) | 
|  | ; | 
|  | if (!loc) | 
|  | error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return loc; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT. | 
|  | If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect, | 
|  | which ends with a period (no newline).  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to | 
|  | hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the | 
|  | watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time.  */ | 
|  | if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Mark breakpoint locations modified.  */ | 
|  | mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint () | 
|  | && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *location; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next) | 
|  | target_disable_tracepoint (location); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
|  |  | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A callback for iterate_over_related_breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | do_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore) | 
|  | { | 
|  | disable_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls | 
|  | disable_breakpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | do_map_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore) | 
|  | { | 
|  | iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_disable_breakpoint, NULL); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | disable_command (char *args, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (args == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *bpt; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt) | 
|  | if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt)) | 
|  | disable_breakpoint (bpt); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *num = extract_arg (&args); | 
|  |  | 
|  | while (num) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (strchr (num, '.')) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (num); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (loc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (loc->enabled) | 
|  | { | 
|  | loc->enabled = 0; | 
|  | mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc); | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint () | 
|  | && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner | 
|  | && is_tracepoint (loc->owner)) | 
|  | target_disable_tracepoint (loc); | 
|  | } | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | map_breakpoint_numbers (num, do_map_disable_breakpoint, NULL); | 
|  | num = extract_arg (&args); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition, | 
|  | int count) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int target_resources_ok; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i; | 
|  | i = hw_breakpoint_used_count (); | 
|  | target_resources_ok = | 
|  | target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint, | 
|  | i + 1, 0); | 
|  | if (target_resources_ok == 0) | 
|  | error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target.")); | 
|  | else if (target_resources_ok < 0) | 
|  | error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit.")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (is_watchpoint (bpt)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning.  */ | 
|  | enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled; | 
|  |  | 
|  | TRY | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt; | 
|  |  | 
|  | orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state; | 
|  | bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled; | 
|  | update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */); | 
|  | } | 
|  | CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state; | 
|  | exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "), | 
|  | bpt->number); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  | END_CATCH | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Mark breakpoint locations modified.  */ | 
|  | mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint () | 
|  | && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *location; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next) | 
|  | target_enable_tracepoint (location); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bpt->disposition = disposition; | 
|  | bpt->enable_count = count; | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
|  |  | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *arg) | 
|  | { | 
|  | enable_breakpoint (bpt); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls | 
|  | enable_breakpoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | do_map_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore) | 
|  | { | 
|  | iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_enable_breakpoint, NULL); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined | 
|  | breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective | 
|  | in stopping the inferior.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | enable_command (char *args, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (args == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *bpt; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt) | 
|  | if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt)) | 
|  | enable_breakpoint (bpt); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *num = extract_arg (&args); | 
|  |  | 
|  | while (num) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (strchr (num, '.')) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (num); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (loc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!loc->enabled) | 
|  | { | 
|  | loc->enabled = 1; | 
|  | mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc); | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint () | 
|  | && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner | 
|  | && is_tracepoint (loc->owner)) | 
|  | target_enable_tracepoint (loc); | 
|  | } | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | map_breakpoint_numbers (num, do_map_enable_breakpoint, NULL); | 
|  | num = extract_arg (&args); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This struct packages up disposition data for application to multiple | 
|  | breakpoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct disp_data | 
|  | { | 
|  | enum bpdisp disp; | 
|  | int count; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | do_enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *arg) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct disp_data disp_data = *(struct disp_data *) arg; | 
|  |  | 
|  | enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_data.disp, disp_data.count); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | do_map_enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct disp_data disp = { disp_disable, 1 }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_once_breakpoint, NULL); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | do_map_enable_count_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *countptr) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct disp_data disp = { disp_disable, *(int *) countptr }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | enable_count_command (char *args, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int count; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (args == NULL) | 
|  | error_no_arg (_("hit count")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | count = get_number (&args); | 
|  |  | 
|  | map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_count_breakpoint, &count); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | do_map_enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct disp_data disp = { disp_del, 1 }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_delete_breakpoint, NULL); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if | 
|  | the memory which that value represents has been written to by | 
|  | GDB itself.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len, | 
|  | const bfd_byte *data) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *bp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp) | 
|  | if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled | 
|  | && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (wp->val_valid && wp->val) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next) | 
|  | if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint | 
|  | && loc->address + loc->length > addr | 
|  | && addr + len > loc->address) | 
|  | { | 
|  | value_free (wp->val); | 
|  | wp->val = NULL; | 
|  | wp->val_valid = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR next_pc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread (); | 
|  | struct symtab_and_line sal; | 
|  | CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | tp->control.single_step_breakpoints | 
|  | = new_single_step_breakpoint (tp->global_num, gdbarch); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0); | 
|  | sal.pc = pc; | 
|  | sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc); | 
|  | sal.explicit_pc = 1; | 
|  | add_location_to_breakpoint (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints, &sal); | 
|  |  | 
|  | update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Insert single step breakpoints according to the current state.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | insert_single_step_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct regcache *regcache = get_current_regcache (); | 
|  | VEC (CORE_ADDR) * next_pcs; | 
|  |  | 
|  | next_pcs = gdbarch_software_single_step (gdbarch, regcache); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (next_pcs != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int i; | 
|  | CORE_ADDR pc; | 
|  | struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame (); | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace = get_frame_address_space (frame); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (CORE_ADDR, next_pcs, i, pc); i++) | 
|  | insert_single_step_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, pc); | 
|  |  | 
|  | VEC_free (CORE_ADDR, next_pcs); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See breakpoint.h.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp, | 
|  | struct address_space *aspace, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR pc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next) | 
|  | if (loc->inserted | 
|  | && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc)) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at | 
|  | PC.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, | 
|  | CORE_ADDR pc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *bpt; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bpt->type == bp_single_step | 
|  | && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc)) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Tracepoint-specific operations.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set tracepoint count to NUM.  */ | 
|  | static void | 
|  | set_tracepoint_count (int num) | 
|  | { | 
|  | tracepoint_count = num; | 
|  | set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint_ops *ops; | 
|  | struct event_location *location; | 
|  | struct cleanup *back_to; | 
|  |  | 
|  | location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language); | 
|  | back_to = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location); | 
|  | if (location != NULL | 
|  | && event_location_type (location) == PROBE_LOCATION) | 
|  | ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | else | 
|  | ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | 
|  | location, | 
|  | NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */, | 
|  | 0 /* tempflag */, | 
|  | bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */, | 
|  | 0 /* Ignore count */, | 
|  | pending_break_support, | 
|  | ops, | 
|  | from_tty, | 
|  | 1 /* enabled */, | 
|  | 0 /* internal */, 0); | 
|  | do_cleanups (back_to); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | ftrace_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct event_location *location; | 
|  | struct cleanup *back_to; | 
|  |  | 
|  | location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language); | 
|  | back_to = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location); | 
|  | create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | 
|  | location, | 
|  | NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */, | 
|  | 0 /* tempflag */, | 
|  | bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */, | 
|  | 0 /* Ignore count */, | 
|  | pending_break_support, | 
|  | &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops, | 
|  | from_tty, | 
|  | 1 /* enabled */, | 
|  | 0 /* internal */, 0); | 
|  | do_cleanups (back_to); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* strace command implementation.  Creates a static tracepoint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | strace_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint_ops *ops; | 
|  | struct event_location *location; | 
|  | struct cleanup *back_to; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'), | 
|  | or with a normal static tracepoint.  */ | 
|  | if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2])) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | location = new_linespec_location (&arg); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | back_to = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location); | 
|  | create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | 
|  | location, | 
|  | NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */, | 
|  | 0 /* tempflag */, | 
|  | bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */, | 
|  | 0 /* Ignore count */, | 
|  | pending_break_support, | 
|  | ops, | 
|  | from_tty, | 
|  | 1 /* enabled */, | 
|  | 0 /* internal */, 0); | 
|  | do_cleanups (back_to); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked | 
|  | list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp; | 
|  | static int next_cmd; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static char * | 
|  | read_uploaded_action (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *rslt; | 
|  |  | 
|  | VEC_iterate (char_ptr, this_utp->cmd_strings, next_cmd, rslt); | 
|  |  | 
|  | next_cmd++; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return rslt; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which | 
|  | can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an | 
|  | equivalent GDB tracepoint.  This is not a reliable process, since | 
|  | the target does not necessarily have all the information used when | 
|  | the tracepoint was originally defined.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct tracepoint * | 
|  | create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *addr_str, small_buf[100]; | 
|  | struct tracepoint *tp; | 
|  | struct event_location *location; | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanup; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (utp->at_string) | 
|  | addr_str = utp->at_string; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw | 
|  | address.  Since there is no way to confirm that the address | 
|  | means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the | 
|  | user.  */ | 
|  | warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no " | 
|  | "source location, using raw address"), | 
|  | utp->number); | 
|  | xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr)); | 
|  | addr_str = small_buf; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes.  */ | 
|  | if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string) | 
|  | warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition " | 
|  | "has no source form, ignoring it"), | 
|  | utp->number); | 
|  |  | 
|  | location = string_to_event_location (&addr_str, current_language); | 
|  | cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location); | 
|  | if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | 
|  | location, | 
|  | utp->cond_string, -1, addr_str, | 
|  | 0 /* parse cond/thread */, | 
|  | 0 /* tempflag */, | 
|  | utp->type /* type_wanted */, | 
|  | 0 /* Ignore count */, | 
|  | pending_break_support, | 
|  | &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops, | 
|  | 0 /* from_tty */, | 
|  | utp->enabled /* enabled */, | 
|  | 0 /* internal */, | 
|  | CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanup); | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanup); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Get the tracepoint we just created.  */ | 
|  | tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count); | 
|  | gdb_assert (tp != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (utp->pass > 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass, | 
|  | tp->base.number); | 
|  |  | 
|  | trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a | 
|  | special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line | 
|  | reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting | 
|  | function.  */ | 
|  | if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->cmd_strings)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct command_line *cmd_list; | 
|  |  | 
|  | this_utp = utp; | 
|  | next_cmd = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL, NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | breakpoint_set_commands (&tp->base, cmd_list); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->actions) | 
|  | || !VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->step_actions)) | 
|  | warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions " | 
|  | "have no source form, ignoring them"), | 
|  | utp->number); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Copy any status information that might be available.  */ | 
|  | tp->base.hit_count = utp->hit_count; | 
|  | tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return tp; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if | 
|  | omitted.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | tracepoints_info (char *args, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | 
|  | int num_printed; | 
|  |  | 
|  | num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_tracepoint); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (num_printed == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (args == NULL || *args == '\0') | 
|  | uiout->message ("No tracepoints.\n"); | 
|  | else | 
|  | uiout->message ("No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | default_collect_info (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints. | 
|  | Not supported by all targets.  */ | 
|  | static void | 
|  | enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | enable_command (args, from_tty); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints. | 
|  | Not supported by all targets.  */ | 
|  | static void | 
|  | disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | disable_command (args, from_tty); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument).  */ | 
|  | static void | 
|  | delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | dont_repeat (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (arg == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int breaks_to_delete = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. | 
|  | Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these | 
|  | have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number | 
|  | argument.  */ | 
|  | ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b) | 
|  | if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | breaks_to_delete = 1; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete.  */ | 
|  | if (!from_tty | 
|  | || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? ")))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp) | 
|  | if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b)) | 
|  | delete_breakpoint (b); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_delete_breakpoint, NULL); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Helper function for trace_pass_command.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | tp->pass_count = count; | 
|  | observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (&tp->base); | 
|  | if (from_tty) | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"), | 
|  | tp->base.number, count); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set passcount for tracepoint. | 
|  |  | 
|  | First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number. | 
|  | If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined. | 
|  | Also accepts special argument "all".  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct tracepoint *t1; | 
|  | unsigned int count; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (args == 0 || *args == 0) | 
|  | error (_("passcount command requires an " | 
|  | "argument (count + optional TP num)")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | count = strtoul (args, &args, 10);	/* Count comes first, then TP num.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | args = skip_spaces (args); | 
|  | if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | args += 3;			/* Skip special argument "all".  */ | 
|  | if (*args) | 
|  | error (_("Junk at end of arguments.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b; | 
|  | trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (*args == '\0') | 
|  | { | 
|  | t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL); | 
|  | if (t1) | 
|  | trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | number_or_range_parser parser (args); | 
|  | while (!parser.finished ()) | 
|  | { | 
|  | t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &parser); | 
|  | if (t1) | 
|  | trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct tracepoint * | 
|  | get_tracepoint (int num) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *t; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t) | 
|  | if (t->number == num) | 
|  | return (struct tracepoint *) t; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be | 
|  | different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and | 
|  | reconnecting).  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct tracepoint * | 
|  | get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (t->number_on_target == num) | 
|  | return t; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list. | 
|  | If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG. | 
|  | If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint | 
|  | (tracepoint_count) is returned.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct tracepoint * | 
|  | get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg, | 
|  | number_or_range_parser *parser) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *t; | 
|  | int tpnum; | 
|  | char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (parser != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | gdb_assert (!parser->finished ()); | 
|  | tpnum = parser->get_number (); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg) | 
|  | tpnum = tracepoint_count; | 
|  | else | 
|  | tpnum = get_number (arg); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (tpnum <= 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (instring && *instring) | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"), | 
|  | instring); | 
|  | else | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n")); | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t) | 
|  | if (t->number == tpnum) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return (struct tracepoint *) t; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum); | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (b->thread != -1) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (b->task != 0) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task); | 
|  |  | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to | 
|  | a new script file named FILENAME.  If FILTER is non-NULL, call it | 
|  | on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns | 
|  | non-zero.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | save_breakpoints (char *filename, int from_tty, | 
|  | int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *tp; | 
|  | int any = 0; | 
|  | struct cleanup *cleanup; | 
|  | struct ui_file *fp; | 
|  | int extra_trace_bits = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0) | 
|  | error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See if we have anything to save.  */ | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts.  */ | 
|  | if (filter && !filter (tp)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | any = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (is_tracepoint (tp)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | extra_trace_bits = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We can stop searching.  */ | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!any) | 
|  | { | 
|  | warning (_("Nothing to save.")); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | filename = tilde_expand (filename); | 
|  | cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, filename); | 
|  | fp = gdb_fopen (filename, "w"); | 
|  | if (!fp) | 
|  | error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"), | 
|  | filename, safe_strerror (errno)); | 
|  | make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (fp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (extra_trace_bits) | 
|  | save_trace_state_variables (fp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts.  */ | 
|  | if (filter && !filter (tp)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, fp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't | 
|  | assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match.  Use $bpnum | 
|  | instead.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (tp->cond_string) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "  condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (tp->ignore_count) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "  ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "  commands\n"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | current_uiout->redirect (fp); | 
|  | TRY | 
|  | { | 
|  | print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands->commands, 2); | 
|  | } | 
|  | CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | current_uiout->redirect (NULL); | 
|  | throw_exception (ex); | 
|  | } | 
|  | END_CATCH | 
|  |  | 
|  | current_uiout->redirect (NULL); | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "  end\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable $bpnum\n"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations | 
|  | should be individually disabled.  Watchpoint locations are | 
|  | special, and not user visible.  */ | 
|  | if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location *loc; | 
|  | int n = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++) | 
|  | if (!loc->enabled) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable $bpnum.%d\n", n); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect) | 
|  | fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "set default-collect %s\n", default_collect); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (from_tty) | 
|  | printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), filename); | 
|  | do_cleanups (cleanup); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The `save breakpoints' command.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | save_breakpoints_command (char *args, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The `save tracepoints' command.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | save_tracepoints_command (char *args, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Create a vector of all tracepoints.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | VEC(breakpoint_p) * | 
|  | all_tracepoints (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0; | 
|  | struct breakpoint *tp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return tp_vec; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying | 
|  | locations used by several commands.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \ | 
|  | "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\ | 
|  | source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\ | 
|  | Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\ | 
|  | function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\ | 
|  | \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\ | 
|  | \n\ | 
|  | Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\ | 
|  | program.  Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\ | 
|  | \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\ | 
|  | \n\ | 
|  | Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\ | 
|  | syntax to specify location parameters.\n\ | 
|  | Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\ | 
|  | function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\ | 
|  | -function fact -label the_top\".\n" | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak | 
|  | commands.  It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication. | 
|  | COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the | 
|  | command.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \ | 
|  | command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\ | 
|  | PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\ | 
|  | probe point.  Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\ | 
|  | guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\ | 
|  | `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\ | 
|  | LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\ | 
|  | below.\n\ | 
|  | \n\ | 
|  | With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\ | 
|  | stack frame.  This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\ | 
|  | \n\ | 
|  | THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\ | 
|  | CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\ | 
|  | \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\ | 
|  | Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\ | 
|  | conditions are different.\n\ | 
|  | \n\ | 
|  | Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints." | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* List of subcommands for "catch".  */ | 
|  | static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* List of subcommands for "tcatch".  */ | 
|  | static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist; | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring, | 
|  | cmd_sfunc_ftype *sfunc, | 
|  | completer_ftype *completer, | 
|  | void *user_data_catch, | 
|  | void *user_data_tcatch) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cmd_list_element *command; | 
|  |  | 
|  | command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring, | 
|  | &catch_cmdlist); | 
|  | set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc); | 
|  | set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch); | 
|  | set_cmd_completer (command, completer); | 
|  |  | 
|  | command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring, | 
|  | &tcatch_cmdlist); | 
|  | set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc); | 
|  | set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch); | 
|  | set_cmd_completer (command, completer); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | save_command (char *arg, int from_tty) | 
|  | { | 
|  | printf_unfiltered (_("\"save\" must be followed by " | 
|  | "the name of a save subcommand.\n")); | 
|  | help_list (save_cmdlist, "save ", all_commands, gdb_stdout); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct breakpoint * | 
|  | iterate_over_breakpoints (int (*callback) (struct breakpoint *, void *), | 
|  | void *data) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if ((*callback) (b, data)) | 
|  | return b; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where | 
|  | functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a | 
|  | non-inline function.  */ | 
|  | if (b->type == bp_shlib_event) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions | 
|  | have been inlined.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | int | 
|  | pc_at_non_inline_function (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc, | 
|  | const struct target_waitstatus *ws) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct breakpoint *b; | 
|  | struct bp_location *bl; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!is_non_inline_function (b)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!bl->shlib_disabled | 
|  | && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws)) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bp_location **locp, *loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp) | 
|  | if (loc->symtab != NULL && SYMTAB_OBJFILE (loc->symtab) == objfile) | 
|  | loc->symtab = NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | initialize_breakpoint_ops (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | static int initialized = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct breakpoint_ops *ops; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (initialized) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | initialized = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of | 
|  | breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints, | 
|  | internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.).  */ | 
|  | ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | *ops = base_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set; | 
|  | ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location; | 
|  | ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location; | 
|  | ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit; | 
|  | ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_create_sals_from_location; | 
|  | ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal; | 
|  | ops->decode_location = bkpt_decode_location; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set; | 
|  | ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed; | 
|  | ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it; | 
|  | ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention; | 
|  | ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Ranged breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint; | 
|  | ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint; | 
|  | ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint; | 
|  | ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint; | 
|  | ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint; | 
|  | ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint; | 
|  | ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Internal breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set; | 
|  | ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status; | 
|  | ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it; | 
|  | ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Momentary breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set; | 
|  | ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status; | 
|  | ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it; | 
|  | ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Momentary breakpoints for bp_longjmp and bp_exception.  */ | 
|  | ops = &longjmp_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | *ops = momentary_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | ops->dtor = longjmp_bkpt_dtor; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Probe breakpoints.  */ | 
|  | ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location; | 
|  | ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location; | 
|  | ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location; | 
|  | ops->decode_location = bkpt_probe_decode_location; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Watchpoints.  */ | 
|  | ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | *ops = base_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | ops->dtor = dtor_watchpoint; | 
|  | ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint; | 
|  | ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint; | 
|  | ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint; | 
|  | ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint; | 
|  | ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint; | 
|  | ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint; | 
|  | ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint; | 
|  | ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint; | 
|  | ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint; | 
|  | ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint; | 
|  | ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Masked watchpoints.  */ | 
|  | ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint; | 
|  | ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint; | 
|  | ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint; | 
|  | ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint; | 
|  | ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint; | 
|  | ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint; | 
|  | ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint; | 
|  | ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Tracepoints.  */ | 
|  | ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | *ops = base_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set; | 
|  | ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit; | 
|  | ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail; | 
|  | ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention; | 
|  | ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate; | 
|  | ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_create_sals_from_location; | 
|  | ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal; | 
|  | ops->decode_location = tracepoint_decode_location; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Probe tracepoints.  */ | 
|  | ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location; | 
|  | ops->decode_location = tracepoint_probe_decode_location; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m').  */ | 
|  | ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | ops->create_sals_from_location = strace_marker_create_sals_from_location; | 
|  | ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal; | 
|  | ops->decode_location = strace_marker_decode_location; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Fork catchpoints.  */ | 
|  | ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | *ops = base_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork; | 
|  | ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork; | 
|  | ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork; | 
|  | ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork; | 
|  | ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork; | 
|  | ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork; | 
|  | ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Vfork catchpoints.  */ | 
|  | ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | *ops = base_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork; | 
|  | ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork; | 
|  | ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork; | 
|  | ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork; | 
|  | ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork; | 
|  | ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork; | 
|  | ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Exec catchpoints.  */ | 
|  | ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | *ops = base_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | ops->dtor = dtor_catch_exec; | 
|  | ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec; | 
|  | ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec; | 
|  | ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec; | 
|  | ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec; | 
|  | ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec; | 
|  | ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec; | 
|  | ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Solib-related catchpoints.  */ | 
|  | ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | *ops = base_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | ops->dtor = dtor_catch_solib; | 
|  | ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib; | 
|  | ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib; | 
|  | ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib; | 
|  | ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib; | 
|  | ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib; | 
|  | ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib; | 
|  | ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib; | 
|  | ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops; | 
|  | ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set; | 
|  | ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed; | 
|  | ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it; | 
|  | ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention; | 
|  | ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate; | 
|  | ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true; | 
|  | ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | _initialize_breakpoint (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cmd_list_element *c; | 
|  |  | 
|  | initialize_breakpoint_ops (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib); | 
|  | observer_attach_free_objfile (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile); | 
|  | observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change); | 
|  |  | 
|  | breakpoint_objfile_key | 
|  | = register_objfile_data_with_cleanup (NULL, free_breakpoint_probes); | 
|  |  | 
|  | breakpoint_chain = 0; | 
|  | /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count.  $bpnum isn't useful | 
|  | before a breakpoint is set.  */ | 
|  | breakpoint_count = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | tracepoint_count = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\ | 
|  | Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\ | 
|  | Usage is `ignore N COUNT'.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\ | 
|  | Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\ | 
|  | Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\ | 
|  | With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\ | 
|  | The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\ | 
|  | Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\ | 
|  | Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\ | 
|  | then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\ | 
|  | Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\ | 
|  | Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\ | 
|  | expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached.")); | 
|  | set_cmd_completer (c, condition_completer); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\ | 
|  | Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\ | 
|  | Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\ | 
|  | so it will be deleted when hit.  Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\ | 
|  | by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\ | 
|  | \n" | 
|  | BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak"))); | 
|  | set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\ | 
|  | Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\ | 
|  | Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\ | 
|  | some target hardware may not have this support.\n\ | 
|  | \n" | 
|  | BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak"))); | 
|  | set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\ | 
|  | Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\ | 
|  | Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\ | 
|  | so it will be deleted when hit.\n\ | 
|  | \n" | 
|  | BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak"))); | 
|  | set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\ | 
|  | Enable some breakpoints.\n\ | 
|  | Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\ | 
|  | With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\ | 
|  | This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\ | 
|  | With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."), | 
|  | &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\ | 
|  | Enable some breakpoints.\n\ | 
|  | Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\ | 
|  | This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\ | 
|  | May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"), | 
|  | &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\ | 
|  | Enable breakpoints for one hit.  Give breakpoint numbers.\n\ | 
|  | If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."), | 
|  | &enablebreaklist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\ | 
|  | Enable breakpoints and delete when hit.  Give breakpoint numbers.\n\ | 
|  | If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."), | 
|  | &enablebreaklist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\ | 
|  | Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits.  Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\ | 
|  | If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\ | 
|  | the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."), | 
|  | &enablebreaklist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\ | 
|  | Enable breakpoints and delete when hit.  Give breakpoint numbers.\n\ | 
|  | If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."), | 
|  | &enablelist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\ | 
|  | Enable breakpoints for one hit.  Give breakpoint numbers.\n\ | 
|  | If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."), | 
|  | &enablelist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\ | 
|  | Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits.  Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\ | 
|  | If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\ | 
|  | the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."), | 
|  | &enablelist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\ | 
|  | Disable some breakpoints.\n\ | 
|  | Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\ | 
|  | To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\ | 
|  | A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."), | 
|  | &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist); | 
|  | add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1); | 
|  | add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\ | 
|  | Disable some breakpoints.\n\ | 
|  | Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\ | 
|  | To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\ | 
|  | A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\ | 
|  | This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."), | 
|  | &disablelist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\ | 
|  | Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\ | 
|  | Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\ | 
|  | To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\ | 
|  | \n\ | 
|  | Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\ | 
|  | The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."), | 
|  | &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist); | 
|  | add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1); | 
|  | add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\ | 
|  | Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\ | 
|  | Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\ | 
|  | To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\ | 
|  | This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."), | 
|  | &deletelist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\ | 
|  | Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\ | 
|  | Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\ | 
|  | \n\ | 
|  | With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\ | 
|  | is executing in.\n" | 
|  | "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\ | 
|  | See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number.")); | 
|  | add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\ | 
|  | Set breakpoint at specified location.\n" | 
|  | BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break"))); | 
|  | set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1); | 
|  | add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1); | 
|  | add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1); | 
|  | add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (dbx_commands) | 
|  | { | 
|  | add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\ | 
|  | Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."), | 
|  | &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist); | 
|  | add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command, | 
|  | _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist); | 
|  | add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command, | 
|  | _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist); | 
|  | add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\ | 
|  | Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\ | 
|  | The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\ | 
|  | \tbreakpoint     - normal breakpoint\n\ | 
|  | \twatchpoint     - watchpoint\n\ | 
|  | The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\ | 
|  | the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit.  \"dis\" means that the\n\ | 
|  | breakpoint will be disabled.  The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\ | 
|  | address and file/line number respectively.\n\ | 
|  | \n\ | 
|  | Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\ | 
|  | are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\ | 
|  | is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\ | 
|  | Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\ | 
|  | breakpoint set.")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\ | 
|  | Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\ | 
|  | The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\ | 
|  | \tbreakpoint     - normal breakpoint\n\ | 
|  | \twatchpoint     - watchpoint\n\ | 
|  | The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\ | 
|  | the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit.  \"dis\" means that the\n\ | 
|  | breakpoint will be disabled.  The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\ | 
|  | address and file/line number respectively.\n\ | 
|  | \n\ | 
|  | Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\ | 
|  | are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\ | 
|  | is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\ | 
|  | Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\ | 
|  | breakpoint set.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\ | 
|  | Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\ | 
|  | The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\ | 
|  | \tbreakpoint     - normal breakpoint\n\ | 
|  | \twatchpoint     - watchpoint\n\ | 
|  | \tlongjmp        - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\ | 
|  | \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\ | 
|  | \tuntil          - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\ | 
|  | \tfinish         - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\ | 
|  | The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\ | 
|  | the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit.  \"dis\" means that the\n\ | 
|  | breakpoint will be disabled.  The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\ | 
|  | address and file/line number respectively.\n\ | 
|  | \n\ | 
|  | Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\ | 
|  | are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\ | 
|  | is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\ | 
|  | Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\ | 
|  | breakpoint set."), | 
|  | &maintenanceinfolist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\ | 
|  | Set catchpoints to catch events."), | 
|  | &catch_cmdlist, "catch ", | 
|  | 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\ | 
|  | Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."), | 
|  | &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ", | 
|  | 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."), | 
|  | catch_fork_command_1, | 
|  | NULL, | 
|  | (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent, | 
|  | (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary); | 
|  | add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."), | 
|  | catch_fork_command_1, | 
|  | NULL, | 
|  | (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent, | 
|  | (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary); | 
|  | add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."), | 
|  | catch_exec_command_1, | 
|  | NULL, | 
|  | CATCH_PERMANENT, | 
|  | CATCH_TEMPORARY); | 
|  | add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\ | 
|  | Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\ | 
|  | If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."), | 
|  | catch_load_command_1, | 
|  | NULL, | 
|  | CATCH_PERMANENT, | 
|  | CATCH_TEMPORARY); | 
|  | add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\ | 
|  | Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\ | 
|  | If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."), | 
|  | catch_unload_command_1, | 
|  | NULL, | 
|  | CATCH_PERMANENT, | 
|  | CATCH_TEMPORARY); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\ | 
|  | Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\ | 
|  | Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\ | 
|  | A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\ | 
|  | an expression changes.\n\ | 
|  | If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\ | 
|  | the memory to which it refers.")); | 
|  | set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\ | 
|  | Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\ | 
|  | Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\ | 
|  | A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\ | 
|  | an expression is read.\n\ | 
|  | If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\ | 
|  | the memory to which it refers.")); | 
|  | set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\ | 
|  | Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\ | 
|  | Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\ | 
|  | A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\ | 
|  | an expression is either read or written.\n\ | 
|  | If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\ | 
|  | the memory to which it refers.")); | 
|  | set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_info ("watchpoints", watchpoints_info, _("\ | 
|  | Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument).")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should | 
|  | respond to changes - contrary to the description.  */ | 
|  | add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support, | 
|  | &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\ | 
|  | Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\ | 
|  | Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\ | 
|  | If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\ | 
|  | such is available.  (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\ | 
|  | created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\ | 
|  | hardware.)"), | 
|  | NULL, | 
|  | show_can_use_hw_watchpoints, | 
|  | &setlist, &showlist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Tracepoint manipulation commands.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\ | 
|  | Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\ | 
|  | \n" | 
|  | BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\ | 
|  | Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands.")); | 
|  | set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0); | 
|  | add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1); | 
|  | add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1); | 
|  | add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\ | 
|  | Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\ | 
|  | \n" | 
|  | BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\ | 
|  | Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands.")); | 
|  | set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\ | 
|  | Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\ | 
|  | \n\ | 
|  | strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\ | 
|  | LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\ | 
|  | or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\ | 
|  | If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name.  With\n\ | 
|  | no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\ | 
|  | Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\ | 
|  | This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\ | 
|  | tracing library.  You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\ | 
|  | by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\ | 
|  | \n\ | 
|  | CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\ | 
|  | \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\ | 
|  | Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\ | 
|  | conditions are different.\n\ | 
|  | \n\ | 
|  | Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\ | 
|  | Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands.")); | 
|  | set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\ | 
|  | Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\ | 
|  | Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\ | 
|  | last tracepoint set.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\ | 
|  | Delete specified tracepoints.\n\ | 
|  | Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\ | 
|  | No argument means delete all tracepoints."), | 
|  | &deletelist); | 
|  | add_alias_cmd ("tr", "tracepoints", class_trace, 1, &deletelist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\ | 
|  | Disable specified tracepoints.\n\ | 
|  | Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\ | 
|  | No argument means disable all tracepoints."), | 
|  | &disablelist); | 
|  | deprecate_cmd (c, "disable"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\ | 
|  | Enable specified tracepoints.\n\ | 
|  | Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\ | 
|  | No argument means enable all tracepoints."), | 
|  | &enablelist); | 
|  | deprecate_cmd (c, "enable"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\ | 
|  | Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\ | 
|  | The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\ | 
|  | Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\ | 
|  | if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, save_command, | 
|  | _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."), | 
|  | &save_cmdlist, "save ", | 
|  | 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\ | 
|  | Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\ | 
|  | This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\ | 
|  | catchpoints, tracepoints).  Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\ | 
|  | session to restore them."), | 
|  | &save_cmdlist); | 
|  | set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\ | 
|  | Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\ | 
|  | Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."), | 
|  | &save_cmdlist); | 
|  | set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0); | 
|  | deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\ | 
|  | Breakpoint specific settings\n\ | 
|  | Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\ | 
|  | pending breakpoint behavior"), | 
|  | &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ", | 
|  | 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist); | 
|  | add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\ | 
|  | Breakpoint specific settings\n\ | 
|  | Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\ | 
|  | pending breakpoint behavior"), | 
|  | &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ", | 
|  | 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class, | 
|  | &pending_break_support, _("\ | 
|  | Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\ | 
|  | Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\ | 
|  | If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\ | 
|  | pending breakpoint.  If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\ | 
|  | an error.  If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\ | 
|  | user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."), | 
|  | NULL, | 
|  | show_pending_break_support, | 
|  | &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, | 
|  | &breakpoint_show_cmdlist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO; | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class, | 
|  | &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\ | 
|  | Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\ | 
|  | Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\ | 
|  | If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\ | 
|  | breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory.  If not set,\n\ | 
|  | a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."), | 
|  | NULL, | 
|  | show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints, | 
|  | &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, | 
|  | &breakpoint_show_cmdlist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support, | 
|  | &always_inserted_mode, _("\ | 
|  | Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\ | 
|  | Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\ | 
|  | When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\ | 
|  | they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\ | 
|  | only when the user deletes them.  When this mode is off (the default),\n\ | 
|  | breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\ | 
|  | when execution stops."), | 
|  | NULL, | 
|  | &show_always_inserted_mode, | 
|  | &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, | 
|  | &breakpoint_show_cmdlist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint, | 
|  | condition_evaluation_enums, | 
|  | &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\ | 
|  | Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\ | 
|  | Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\ | 
|  | When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\ | 
|  | evaluated on the host's side by GDB.  When it is set to \"target\",\n\ | 
|  | breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\ | 
|  | supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\ | 
|  | If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\ | 
|  | \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\ | 
|  | be set to \"gdb\""), | 
|  | &set_condition_evaluation_mode, | 
|  | &show_condition_evaluation_mode, | 
|  | &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, | 
|  | &breakpoint_show_cmdlist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\ | 
|  | Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\ | 
|  | break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\ | 
|  | where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\ | 
|  | LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\ | 
|  | FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\ | 
|  | +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\ | 
|  | or the start of the range\n\ | 
|  | FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\ | 
|  | FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\ | 
|  | *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\ | 
|  | \n\ | 
|  | The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\ | 
|  | an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\ | 
|  | range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION).")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\ | 
|  | Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\ | 
|  | dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\ | 
|  | location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n" | 
|  | "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING)); | 
|  | set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support, | 
|  | dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\ | 
|  | Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\ | 
|  | Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\ | 
|  | This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\ | 
|  | If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\ | 
|  | console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\ | 
|  | If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\ | 
|  | program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\ | 
|  | output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."), | 
|  | update_dprintf_commands, NULL, | 
|  | &setlist, &showlist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf"); | 
|  | add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support, | 
|  | &dprintf_function, _("\ | 
|  | Set the function to use for dynamic printf"), _("\ | 
|  | Show the function to use for dynamic printf"), NULL, | 
|  | update_dprintf_commands, NULL, | 
|  | &setlist, &showlist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | dprintf_channel = xstrdup (""); | 
|  | add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support, | 
|  | &dprintf_channel, _("\ | 
|  | Set the channel to use for dynamic printf"), _("\ | 
|  | Show the channel to use for dynamic printf"), NULL, | 
|  | update_dprintf_commands, NULL, | 
|  | &setlist, &showlist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class, | 
|  | &disconnected_dprintf, _("\ | 
|  | Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\ | 
|  | Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\ | 
|  | Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\ | 
|  | even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."), | 
|  | NULL, | 
|  | NULL, | 
|  | &setlist, &showlist); | 
|  |  | 
|  | add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\ | 
|  | agent-printf \"printf format string\", arg1, arg2, arg3, ..., argn\n\ | 
|  | (target agent only) This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands.")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed); | 
|  | observer_attach_thread_exit (remove_threaded_breakpoints); | 
|  | } |